blob: dd96148edb27277234489933413e889aa1498ca4 [file] [log] [blame]
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001//===- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes --------------===//
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000016#include "clang/AST/APValue.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000017#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTTypeTraits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000020#include "clang/AST/AttrIterator.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000021#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000022#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000023#include "clang/AST/Decl.h"
24#include "clang/AST/DeclBase.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000025#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Chandler Carruthaa36b892015-12-30 03:40:23 +000026#include "clang/AST/DeclContextInternals.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000027#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000028#include "clang/AST/DeclOpenMP.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000029#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000030#include "clang/AST/DeclarationName.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000031#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000032#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000033#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000034#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +000035#include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000036#include "clang/AST/NestedNameSpecifier.h"
37#include "clang/AST/RawCommentList.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000038#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +000039#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000040#include "clang/AST/Stmt.h"
41#include "clang/AST/TemplateBase.h"
42#include "clang/AST/TemplateName.h"
43#include "clang/AST/Type.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000044#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000045#include "clang/AST/UnresolvedSet.h"
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +000046#include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000047#include "clang/Basic/AddressSpaces.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000048#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000049#include "clang/Basic/CommentOptions.h"
50#include "clang/Basic/IdentifierTable.h"
51#include "clang/Basic/LLVM.h"
52#include "clang/Basic/LangOptions.h"
53#include "clang/Basic/Linkage.h"
54#include "clang/Basic/ObjCRuntime.h"
55#include "clang/Basic/SanitizerBlacklist.h"
56#include "clang/Basic/SourceLocation.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000057#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000058#include "clang/Basic/Specifiers.h"
59#include "clang/Basic/TargetCXXABI.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000060#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000061#include "clang/Basic/XRayLists.h"
62#include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
63#include "llvm/ADT/APSInt.h"
64#include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
65#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
66#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
67#include "llvm/ADT/FoldingSet.h"
68#include "llvm/ADT/None.h"
69#include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
70#include "llvm/ADT/PointerUnion.h"
71#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
72#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
73#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000074#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000075#include "llvm/ADT/StringRef.h"
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +000076#include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000077#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000078#include "llvm/Support/Casting.h"
79#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
80#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000081#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000082#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000083#include <algorithm>
84#include <cassert>
85#include <cstddef>
86#include <cstdint>
87#include <cstdlib>
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000088#include <map>
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +000089#include <memory>
90#include <string>
91#include <tuple>
92#include <utility>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000093
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000094using namespace clang;
95
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000096unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
97unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000098unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
99unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +0000100unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
101unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +0000102unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
103unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +0000104unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
105unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000106unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
107unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
108
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +0000109enum FloatingRank {
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +0000110 Float16Rank, HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank, Float128Rank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +0000111};
112
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +0000113RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000114 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
115 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
Dmitri Gribenko9ee0e302014-03-27 15:40:39 +0000116
117#ifndef NDEBUG
118 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
119 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
120 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
121#endif
122
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000123 CommentsLoaded = true;
124 }
125
126 assert(D);
127
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +0000128 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
129 if (D->isImplicit())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000130 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +0000131
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000132 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
133 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
134 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000135 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000136 }
137
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000138 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
139 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
140 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000141 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000142 }
143
144 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
145 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000146 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000147 }
148
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000149 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
150 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
151 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
152 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
153 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000154 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000155 }
156
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000157 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
158 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000159 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +0000160 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000161 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
162 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
163 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
164 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000165 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000166 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000167 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
168 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000169 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000170
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000171 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
172 // documentation.
173 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
174 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
175 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000176 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000177
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000178 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000179
180 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
181 if (RawComments.empty())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000182 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000183
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000184 // Find declaration location.
185 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
186 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
187 // location".
188 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
189 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
190 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
191 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000192 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000193 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
194 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000195 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000196 else {
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000197 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
Dmitri Gribenkoef099dc2014-03-27 16:40:51 +0000198 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
199 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
200 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
201 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
202 // the "declaration location".
203 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
204 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
205 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
206 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
207 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
208 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
209 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
210 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
211 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
212 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
213 }
214 }
Fariborz Jahanianb64e95f2013-07-24 22:58:51 +0000215 }
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000216
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000217 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
218 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000219 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000220 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000221
222 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000223 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
224 {
225 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
226 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
227 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000228 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
229 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
230 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000231 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
232 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
233 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
234 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
235 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
236 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
237 }
238
239 if (Found) {
240 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
241 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
242 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
243 } else {
244 // Slow path.
245 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
246 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
247 }
248 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000249
250 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
251 // file buffer.
252 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
253
254 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
255 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000256 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Fariborz Jahanianfad28542013-08-06 23:29:00 +0000257 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
Fariborz Jahanian3ab62222013-08-07 16:40:29 +0000258 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000259 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000260 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000261 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
262 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
263 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
264 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
265 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
266 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000267 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000268 }
269 }
270
271 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
272 // Let's look at the previous comment.
273 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000274 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000275 --Comment;
276
277 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000278 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000279 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000280
281 // Decompose the end of the comment.
282 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000283 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000284
285 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
286 // aren't related.
287 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000288 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000289
290 // Get the corresponding buffer.
291 bool Invalid = false;
292 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
293 &Invalid).data();
294 if (Invalid)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000295 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000296
297 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
298 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
299 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
300
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000301 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
302 // comment and declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb534d3a2013-07-26 18:38:12 +0000303 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000304 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000305
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000306 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000307}
308
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000309/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
310/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000311/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +0000312static const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000313 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000314 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000315 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000316 return FTD;
317
318 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
319 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
320 return D;
321
322 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
323 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
324 return FTD;
325
326 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
327 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
328 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
329 return MemberDecl;
330
331 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000332 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000333 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
334 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
335 // template?
336 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
337 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
338 return MemberDecl;
339
340 return D;
341 }
342 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
343 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
344 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
345 return CTD;
346
347 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
348 // specialization?
349 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
350 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
351 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
352 return D;
353 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
354 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
355 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
356 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
357 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
358 static_cast<const Decl*>(
359 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
360 }
361
362 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
363 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
364 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
365 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
366
367 return D;
368 }
369 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
370 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
371 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
372 return MemberDecl;
373
374 return D;
375 }
376 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000377 return D;
378}
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000379
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000380const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
381 const Decl *D,
382 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000383 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000384
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000385 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
386 {
387 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
388 RedeclComments.find(D);
389 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
390 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000391 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
392 if (OriginalDecl)
393 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000394 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000395 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000396 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000397 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000398
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000399 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000400 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
401 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000402 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000403 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000404 RedeclComments.find(I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000405 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
406 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
407 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
408 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000409 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000410 break;
411 }
412 } else {
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000413 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
414 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000415 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
416 if (RC) {
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000417 // Call order swapped to work around ICE in VS2015 RTM (Release Win32)
418 // https://connect.microsoft.com/VisualStudio/feedback/details/1741530
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000419 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
Will Wilsonf9de5362015-10-27 17:01:10 +0000420 Raw.setRaw(RC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000421 } else
422 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000423 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
424 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000425 if (RC)
426 break;
427 }
428 }
429
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000430 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
431 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000432
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000433 if (OriginalDecl)
434 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
435
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000436 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
437 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
438 Raw.setRaw(RC);
439 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000440 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000441
Aaron Ballman86c93902014-03-06 23:45:36 +0000442 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
443 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000444 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
445 R = Raw;
446 }
447
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000448 return RC;
449}
450
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000451static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
452 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
453 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
454 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
455 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
456 if (!ID)
457 return;
458 // Add redeclared method here.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +0000459 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000460 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000461 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000462 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
463 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
464 }
465 }
466}
467
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000468comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
469 const Decl *D) const {
470 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
471 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
472 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
473 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
474 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7daabbd2014-04-27 22:53:03 +0000475 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
476 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000477 comments::FullComment *CFC =
478 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
479 ThisDeclInfo);
480 return CFC;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000481}
482
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000483comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
484 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000485 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
Richard Smithb39b9d52013-05-21 05:24:00 +0000486}
487
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000488comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
489 const Decl *D,
490 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Fariborz Jahanian096f7c12013-05-13 17:27:00 +0000491 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000492 return nullptr;
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000493 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000494
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000495 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
496 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
497 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000498
499 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000500 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000501 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000502 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000503 return CFC;
504 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000505 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000506 }
507
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000508 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000509
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000510 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000511 if (!RC) {
512 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000513 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000514 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000515 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
516 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
517 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
518 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000519 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000520 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
521 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000522 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
523 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
524 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000525 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000526 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000527 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000528 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000529 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000530 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
531 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
532 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000533 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000534 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000535 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
536 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
537 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
538 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
539 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
540 }
541 }
542 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
543 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
544 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
545 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
546 }
547 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
548 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000549 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000550 // Check non-virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000551 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
552 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000553 continue;
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +0000554 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000555 if (Ty.isNull())
556 continue;
557 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
558 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
559 continue;
560
561 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
562 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
563 }
564 }
565 // Check virtual bases.
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000566 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
567 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000568 continue;
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +0000569 QualType Ty = I.getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000570 if (Ty.isNull())
571 continue;
572 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
573 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
574 continue;
575 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
576 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
577 }
578 }
579 }
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000580 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000581 }
582
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000583 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
584 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
585 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
586 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000587 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000588 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000589
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000590 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000591 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
592 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000593}
594
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000595void
596ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
597 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
598 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
599 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000600 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000601
602 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
603 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
604 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
605 PEnd = Params->end();
606 P != PEnd; ++P) {
607 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
608 ID.AddInteger(0);
609 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
610 continue;
611 }
612
613 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
614 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000615 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000616 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000617 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
618 ID.AddBoolean(true);
619 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000620 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
621 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
622 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
623 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000624 } else
625 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000626 continue;
627 }
628
629 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
630 ID.AddInteger(2);
631 Profile(ID, TTP);
632 }
633}
634
635TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
636ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000637 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000638 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
639 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
640 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000641 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000642 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
643 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
644 if (Canonical)
645 return Canonical->getParam();
646
647 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
648 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000649 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000650 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
651 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
652 PEnd = Params->end();
653 P != PEnd; ++P) {
654 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
655 CanonParams.push_back(
656 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000657 SourceLocation(),
658 SourceLocation(),
659 TTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000660 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000661 TTP->isParameterPack()));
662 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000663 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
664 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
665 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
666 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
667 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000668 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
669 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000670 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
671 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
672 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
673 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
674 }
675
676 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000677 SourceLocation(),
678 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000679 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000680 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000681 T,
682 TInfo,
David Majnemerdfecf1a2016-07-06 04:19:16 +0000683 ExpandedTypes,
684 ExpandedTInfos);
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000685 } else {
686 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000687 SourceLocation(),
688 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000689 NTTP->getDepth(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000690 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000691 T,
692 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
693 TInfo);
694 }
695 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
696
697 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000698 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
699 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
700 }
701
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000702 assert(!TTP->getRequiresClause() &&
703 "Unexpected requires-clause on template template-parameter");
George Burgess IVb7e4e482016-08-25 01:54:37 +0000704 Expr *const CanonRequiresClause = nullptr;
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000705
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000706 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
707 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
708 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000709 TTP->getPosition(),
710 TTP->isParameterPack(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000711 nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000712 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
713 SourceLocation(),
David Majnemer902f8c62015-12-27 07:16:27 +0000714 CanonParams,
Hubert Tonge4a0c0e2016-07-30 22:33:34 +0000715 SourceLocation(),
716 CanonRequiresClause));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000717
718 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
719 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000720 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000721 (void)Canonical;
722
723 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
724 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
725 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
726 return CanonTTP;
727}
728
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000729CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +0000730 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000731
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000732 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000733 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000734 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +0000735 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +0000736 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Joerg Sonnenbergerdaa13aa2014-05-13 11:20:16 +0000737 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +0000738 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000739 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +0000740 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000741 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000742 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000743 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
744 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000745 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000746}
747
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +0000748static const LangASMap *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
749 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000750 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
751 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
752 // language-specific address space.
753 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
Yaxun Liub34ec822017-04-11 17:24:23 +0000754 0, // Default
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000755 1, // opencl_global
Egor Churaev28f00aa2016-12-23 16:11:25 +0000756 3, // opencl_local
757 2, // opencl_constant
Yaxun Liub7318e02017-10-13 03:37:48 +0000758 0, // opencl_private
Anastasia Stulova2c8dcfb2014-11-26 14:10:06 +0000759 4, // opencl_generic
760 5, // cuda_device
761 6, // cuda_constant
762 7 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000763 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000764 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000765 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000766 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000767 }
768}
769
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000770static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
771 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
772 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000773 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
774 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
775 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
776 return true;
777 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
778 return false;
779 }
NAKAMURA Takumi5c81ca42013-09-13 17:12:09 +0000780 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +0000781}
782
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000783ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000784 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Alp Toker08043432014-05-03 03:46:04 +0000785 Builtin::Context &builtins)
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000786 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
787 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +0000788 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()), SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Alexey Samsonova511cdd2015-02-04 17:40:08 +0000789 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
Dean Michael Berris835832d2017-03-30 00:29:36 +0000790 XRayFilter(new XRayFunctionFilter(LangOpts.XRayAlwaysInstrumentFiles,
791 LangOpts.XRayNeverInstrumentFiles, SM)),
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +0000792 PrintingPolicy(LOpts), Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +0000793 BuiltinInfo(builtins), DeclarationNames(*this), Comments(SM),
Alexey Samsonov0b15e342014-10-15 22:17:27 +0000794 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000795 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
796}
797
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000798ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000799 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
800
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000801 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
802 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
803 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000804
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000805 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000806 for (auto &Pair : Deallocations)
807 (Pair.first)(Pair.second);
Manuel Klimeka7328992013-06-03 13:51:33 +0000808
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000809 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000810 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
811 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
812 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
813 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
814 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
815 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
816 R->Destroy(*this);
817
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000818 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
819 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
820 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
821 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
822 R->Destroy(*this);
823 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000824
825 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
826 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
827 A != AEnd; ++A)
828 A->second->~AttrVec();
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +0000829
David Majnemere694f3e2015-08-14 14:43:50 +0000830 for (std::pair<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue *> &MTVPair :
831 MaterializedTemporaryValues)
832 MTVPair.second->~APValue();
833
Richard Smith423f46f2016-07-20 21:38:26 +0000834 for (const auto &Value : ModuleInitializers)
835 Value.second->~PerModuleInitializers();
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000836}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000837
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000838void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +0000839 if (!PointerParents) return;
840 for (const auto &Entry : *PointerParents) {
841 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
842 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
843 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
844 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
845 }
846 }
847 for (const auto &Entry : *OtherParents) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000848 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
849 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +0000850 } else if (Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>()) {
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +0000851 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
852 }
853 }
854}
855
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000856void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
Chandler Carruthff5a01a2015-12-30 03:00:23 +0000857 Deallocations.push_back({Callback, Data});
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000858}
859
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000860void
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000861ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
Benjamin Kramerd6da1a02016-06-12 20:05:23 +0000862 ExternalSource = std::move(Source);
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000863}
864
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000865void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000866 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
867 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000868
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000869 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000870#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000871#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
872#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
873 0 // Extra
874 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000875
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000876 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
877 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000878 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000879 }
880
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000881 unsigned Idx = 0;
882 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
883#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
884 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000885 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
886 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000887 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
888 ++Idx;
889#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
890#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000891
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000892 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
893
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000894 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000895 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
896 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
897 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
898 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
899 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
900 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000901 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000902 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
903 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
904 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
905 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
906 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
907 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000908 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000909 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
910 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
911 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
912 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
913 << NumImplicitDestructors
914 << " implicit destructors created\n";
915
Argyrios Kyrtzidis1b7ed912014-02-27 04:11:59 +0000916 if (ExternalSource) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000917 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000918 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
919 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000920
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000921 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000922}
923
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000924void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
925 bool NotifyListeners) {
926 if (NotifyListeners)
927 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
928 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
929
Benjamin Kramera72a70a2016-10-17 13:00:44 +0000930 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
931 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
932 else
Richard Smith90dc5252017-06-23 01:04:34 +0000933 ND->setVisibleDespiteOwningModule();
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000934}
935
936void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
937 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
938 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
939 return;
940
Benjamin Kramera72a70a2016-10-17 13:00:44 +0000941 auto &Merged = It->second;
Richard Smith42413142015-05-15 20:05:43 +0000942 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
943 for (Module *&M : Merged)
944 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
945 M = nullptr;
946 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
947}
948
Richard Smithdc1f0422016-07-20 19:10:16 +0000949void ASTContext::PerModuleInitializers::resolve(ASTContext &Ctx) {
950 if (LazyInitializers.empty())
951 return;
952
953 auto *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
954 assert(Source && "lazy initializers but no external source");
955
956 auto LazyInits = std::move(LazyInitializers);
957 LazyInitializers.clear();
958
959 for (auto ID : LazyInits)
960 Initializers.push_back(Source->GetExternalDecl(ID));
961
962 assert(LazyInitializers.empty() &&
963 "GetExternalDecl for lazy module initializer added more inits");
964}
965
966void ASTContext::addModuleInitializer(Module *M, Decl *D) {
967 // One special case: if we add a module initializer that imports another
968 // module, and that module's only initializer is an ImportDecl, simplify.
969 if (auto *ID = dyn_cast<ImportDecl>(D)) {
970 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(ID->getImportedModule());
971
972 // Maybe the ImportDecl does nothing at all. (Common case.)
973 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
974 return;
975
976 // Maybe the ImportDecl only imports another ImportDecl.
977 auto &Imported = *It->second;
978 if (Imported.Initializers.size() + Imported.LazyInitializers.size() == 1) {
979 Imported.resolve(*this);
980 auto *OnlyDecl = Imported.Initializers.front();
981 if (isa<ImportDecl>(OnlyDecl))
982 D = OnlyDecl;
983 }
984 }
985
986 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
987 if (!Inits)
988 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
989 Inits->Initializers.push_back(D);
990}
991
992void ASTContext::addLazyModuleInitializers(Module *M, ArrayRef<uint32_t> IDs) {
993 auto *&Inits = ModuleInitializers[M];
994 if (!Inits)
995 Inits = new (*this) PerModuleInitializers;
996 Inits->LazyInitializers.insert(Inits->LazyInitializers.end(),
997 IDs.begin(), IDs.end());
998}
999
1000ArrayRef<Decl*> ASTContext::getModuleInitializers(Module *M) {
1001 auto It = ModuleInitializers.find(M);
1002 if (It == ModuleInitializers.end())
1003 return None;
1004
1005 auto *Inits = It->second;
1006 Inits->resolve(*this);
1007 return Inits->Initializers;
1008}
1009
Richard Smithf19e1272015-03-07 00:04:49 +00001010ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
1011 if (!ExternCContext)
1012 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
1013
1014 return ExternCContext;
1015}
1016
David Majnemerd9b1a4f2015-11-04 03:40:30 +00001017BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1018ASTContext::buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BuiltinTemplateKind BTK,
1019 const IdentifierInfo *II) const {
1020 auto *BuiltinTemplate = BuiltinTemplateDecl::Create(*this, TUDecl, II, BTK);
1021 BuiltinTemplate->setImplicit();
1022 TUDecl->addDecl(BuiltinTemplate);
1023
1024 return BuiltinTemplate;
1025}
1026
1027BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1028ASTContext::getMakeIntegerSeqDecl() const {
1029 if (!MakeIntegerSeqDecl)
1030 MakeIntegerSeqDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__make_integer_seq,
1031 getMakeIntegerSeqName());
1032 return MakeIntegerSeqDecl;
1033}
1034
Eric Fiselier6ad68552016-07-01 01:24:09 +00001035BuiltinTemplateDecl *
1036ASTContext::getTypePackElementDecl() const {
1037 if (!TypePackElementDecl)
1038 TypePackElementDecl = buildBuiltinTemplateDecl(BTK__type_pack_element,
1039 getTypePackElementName());
1040 return TypePackElementDecl;
1041}
1042
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001043RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
1044 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001045 SourceLocation Loc;
1046 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001047 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
1048 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
1049 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001050 else
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00001051 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
1052 &Idents.get(Name));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001053 NewDecl->setImplicit();
David Majnemerf8637362015-01-15 08:41:25 +00001054 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
1055 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001056 return NewDecl;
1057}
1058
1059TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
1060 StringRef Name) const {
1061 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
1062 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
1063 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
1064 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
1065 NewDecl->setImplicit();
1066 return NewDecl;
1067}
1068
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001069TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001070 if (!Int128Decl)
1071 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001072 return Int128Decl;
1073}
1074
1075TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00001076 if (!UInt128Decl)
1077 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +00001078 return UInt128Decl;
1079}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +00001080
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00001081void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00001082 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00001083 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00001084 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00001085}
1086
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +00001087void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target,
1088 const TargetInfo *AuxTarget) {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001089 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
1090 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001091 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001092
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001093 this->Target = &Target;
Artem Belevichb5bc9232015-09-22 17:23:22 +00001094 this->AuxTarget = AuxTarget;
1095
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001096 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
1097 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
David Tweed31d09b02013-09-13 12:04:22 +00001098 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001099
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001100 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001101 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001102
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001103 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001104 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001105 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +00001106 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +00001107 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
1108 else
1109 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001110 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001111 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
1112 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
1113 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
1114 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
1115 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001116
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001117 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001118 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
1119 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
1120 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
1121 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
1122 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001123
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001124 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +00001125 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
1126 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
1127 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001128
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001129 // GNU extension, __float128 for IEEE quadruple precision
1130 InitBuiltinType(Float128Ty, BuiltinType::Float128);
1131
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00001132 // C11 extension ISO/IEC TS 18661-3
1133 InitBuiltinType(Float16Ty, BuiltinType::Float16);
1134
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00001135 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
1136 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
1137 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
1138
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +00001139 // C++ 3.9.1p5
1140 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
1141 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1142 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1143 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1144 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1145 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1146 else {
1147 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1148 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1149 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001150
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +00001151 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1152
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001153 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1154 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1155 else // C99
1156 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1157
1158 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1159 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1160 else // C99
1161 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1162
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001163 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1164 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1165 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1166 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1167 // expressions.
1168 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001169
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00001170 // Placeholder type for functions.
1171 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1172
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +00001173 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1174 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1175
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001176 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1177 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1178
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +00001179 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1180 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1181
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +00001182 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1183 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1184
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +00001185 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1186 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1187
Alexey Bataev1a3320e2015-08-25 14:24:04 +00001188 // Placeholder type for OMP array sections.
1189 if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
1190 InitBuiltinType(OMPArraySectionTy, BuiltinType::OMPArraySection);
1191
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001192 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00001193 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1194 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1195 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001196 Float128ComplexTy = getComplexType(Float128Ty);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001197
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001198 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001199 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1200 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +00001201 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001202
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00001203 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1204#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1205 InitBuiltinType(SingletonId, BuiltinType::Id);
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00001206#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001207
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001208 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001209 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001210 InitBuiltinType(OCLClkEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent);
1211 InitBuiltinType(OCLQueueTy, BuiltinType::OCLQueue);
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001212 InitBuiltinType(OCLReserveIDTy, BuiltinType::OCLReserveID);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001213 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001214
1215 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +00001216 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1217 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +00001218
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00001219 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00001220
1221 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001222
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00001223 // void * type
Yaxun Liu39195062017-08-04 18:16:31 +00001224 if (LangOpts.OpenCLVersion >= 200) {
1225 auto Q = VoidTy.getQualifiers();
1226 Q.setAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_generic);
1227 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(
1228 getQualifiedType(VoidTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Q)));
1229 } else {
1230 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
1231 }
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001232
1233 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1234 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001235
1236 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1237 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00001238
1239 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00001240 VaListTagDecl = nullptr;
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00001241}
1242
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +00001243DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +00001244 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1245}
1246
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001247AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1248 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1249 if (!Result) {
1250 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1251 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1252 }
1253
1254 return *Result;
1255}
1256
1257/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001258void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +00001259 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1260 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1261 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1262 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1263 }
1264}
1265
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001266// FIXME: Remove ?
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001267MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001268ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001269 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001270 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1271 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1272}
1273
1274ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1275ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1276 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1277 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1278 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1279 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001280
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001281 return Pos->second;
1282}
1283
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001284void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001285ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001286 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1287 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001288 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1289 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00001290 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1291 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1292}
1293
1294void
1295ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1296 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1297 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1298 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1299 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001300}
1301
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001302FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1303 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1304 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1305 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001306 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1307 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001308 return nullptr;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001309
1310 return Pos->second;
1311}
1312
1313void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1314 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1315 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1316 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001317 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001318}
1319
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001320NamedDecl *
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001321ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *UUD) {
1322 auto Pos = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001323 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001324 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001325
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001326 return Pos->second;
1327}
1328
1329void
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001330ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(NamedDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001331 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1332 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1333 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1334 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
Richard Smithd8a9e372016-12-18 21:39:37 +00001335 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Inst) ||
1336 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Inst) ||
1337 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Inst)) &&
1338 "instantiation did not produce a using decl");
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001339 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1340 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1341}
1342
1343UsingShadowDecl *
1344ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1345 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1346 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1347 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001348 return nullptr;
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001349
1350 return Pos->second;
1351}
1352
1353void
1354ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1355 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1356 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1357 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001358}
1359
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001360FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1361 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1362 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1363 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00001364 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001365
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001366 return Pos->second;
1367}
1368
1369void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1370 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1371 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1372 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1373 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1374 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001375
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001376 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1377}
1378
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001379ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1380ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Benjamin Krameracfa3392017-12-17 23:52:45 +00001381 return overridden_methods(Method).begin();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001382}
1383
1384ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1385ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Benjamin Krameracfa3392017-12-17 23:52:45 +00001386 return overridden_methods(Method).end();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001387}
1388
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001389unsigned
1390ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Benjamin Krameracfa3392017-12-17 23:52:45 +00001391 auto Range = overridden_methods(Method);
1392 return Range.end() - Range.begin();
Clement Courbet8251ebf2016-06-10 11:54:43 +00001393}
1394
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001395ASTContext::overridden_method_range
1396ASTContext::overridden_methods(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
Benjamin Krameracfa3392017-12-17 23:52:45 +00001397 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos =
1398 OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1399 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1400 return overridden_method_range(nullptr, nullptr);
1401 return overridden_method_range(Pos->second.begin(), Pos->second.end());
Clement Courbet6ecaec82016-07-05 07:49:31 +00001402}
1403
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001404void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1405 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001406 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001407 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1408}
1409
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001410void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1411 const NamedDecl *D,
1412 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001413 assert(D);
1414
1415 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001416 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1417 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001418 return;
1419 }
1420
1421 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1422 if (!Method)
1423 return;
1424
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001425 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1426 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001427 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001428}
1429
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001430void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1431 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1432 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1433 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1434 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1435 LastLocalImport = Import;
1436 return;
1437 }
1438
1439 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1440 LastLocalImport = Import;
1441}
1442
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001443//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1444// Type Sizing and Analysis
1445//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001446
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001447/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1448/// scalar floating point type.
1449const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001450 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001451 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1452 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001453 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00001454 case BuiltinType::Float16:
1455 case BuiltinType::Half:
1456 return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001457 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1458 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1459 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001460 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Target->getFloat128Format();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001461 }
1462}
1463
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001464CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001465 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001466
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001467 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1468 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1469 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001470
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001471 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1472 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1473 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1474 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001475 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001476 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1477 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1478 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1479 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1480 } else {
1481 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1482 }
1483 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001484 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1485 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1486 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1487 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001488
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001489 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1490 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001491 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001492 // do nothing
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001493 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001494 QualType T = VD->getType();
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001495 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001496 if (ForAlignof)
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001497 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1498 else
1499 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1500 }
Richard Smithf6d70302014-06-10 23:34:28 +00001501 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
Akira Hatanakad62f2c82017-01-06 17:56:15 +00001502 if (T->isFunctionType())
1503 Align = getTypeInfoImpl(T.getTypePtr()).Align;
1504 else if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001505 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1506 // large-array alignment on the target.
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001507 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
Rafael Espindola71eccb32013-08-08 19:53:46 +00001508 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1509 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
Rafael Espindola88572752013-08-07 18:08:19 +00001510 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1511 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1512 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1513 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1514 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1515 }
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001516 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001517 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Roger Ferrer Ibanez3fa38a12017-03-08 14:00:44 +00001518 if (BaseT.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned())
1519 Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001520 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Ulrich Weigandb63f7792015-04-21 17:26:18 +00001521 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001522 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1523 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001524 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001525
1526 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1527 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1528 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1529 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1530 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001531 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1532 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1533 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1534 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1535 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001536
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001537 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1538 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001539
Matt Beaumont-Gay35779952013-06-25 22:19:15 +00001540 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1541 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1542 if (Offset > 0) {
1543 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1544 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1545 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1546 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1547 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1548 }
1549
1550 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001551 }
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001552 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001553 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001554
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001555 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001556}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001557
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001558// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1559// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1560// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1561// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1562std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1563ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1564 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1565
1566 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1567 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1568 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1569 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1570 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1571 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1572 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1573 }
1574 }
1575
1576 return sizeAndAlign;
1577}
1578
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001579/// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1580/// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1581std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1582static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1583 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1584 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1585 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1586 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Trieuc7509072013-05-14 23:41:50 +00001587 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1588 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001589 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1590 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1591 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001592 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1593 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001594 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001595 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1596 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1597}
1598
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001599std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001600ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00001601 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1602 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001603 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1604 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1605 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001606}
1607
1608std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001609ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001610 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1611}
1612
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001613bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1614 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1615}
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001616
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001617bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1618 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1619}
1620
Richard Smithb2f0f052016-10-10 18:54:32 +00001621unsigned ASTContext::getTypeAlignIfKnown(QualType T) const {
1622 // An alignment on a typedef overrides anything else.
1623 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1624 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1625 return Align;
1626
1627 // If we have an (array of) complete type, we're done.
1628 T = getBaseElementType(T);
1629 if (!T->isIncompleteType())
1630 return getTypeAlign(T);
1631
1632 // If we had an array type, its element type might be a typedef
1633 // type with an alignment attribute.
1634 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>())
1635 if (unsigned Align = TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment())
1636 return Align;
1637
1638 // Otherwise, see if the declaration of the type had an attribute.
1639 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TagType>())
1640 return TT->getDecl()->getMaxAlignment();
1641
1642 return 0;
1643}
1644
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001645TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemerf8d38642014-07-30 08:42:33 +00001646 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1647 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1648 return I->second;
1649
1650 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1651 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1652 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
Rafael Espindolaeaa88c12014-07-30 04:40:23 +00001653 return TI;
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001654}
1655
1656/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1657/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001658///
1659/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1660/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1661/// should take a QualType, &c.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001662TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1663 uint64_t Width = 0;
1664 unsigned Align = 8;
1665 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001666 unsigned AS = 0;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001667 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001668#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1669#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001670#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001671#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
David Blaikieab277d62013-07-13 21:08:03 +00001672#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1673 case Type::Class: \
1674 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1675 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001676#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001677 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001678
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001679 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1680 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001681 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1682 Width = 0;
1683 Align = 32;
1684 break;
1685
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001686 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001687 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001688 Width = 0;
1689 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1690 break;
1691
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001692 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001693 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001694
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001695 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001696 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001697 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001698 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001699 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1700 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Warren Hunt5ae586a2013-11-01 23:59:41 +00001701 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1702 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001703 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001704 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001705 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001706 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001707 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001708 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001709 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1710 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001711 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001712 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1713 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001714 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001715 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
Rui Ueyama83aa9792016-01-14 21:00:27 +00001716 Width = llvm::alignTo(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001717 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001718 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1719 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1720 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1721 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001722 break;
1723 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001724
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001725 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001726 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001727 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001728 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001729 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1730 Width = 0;
1731 Align = 8;
1732 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001733 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001734 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1735 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001736 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001737 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1738 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1739 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001740 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001741 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1742 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001743 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001744 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1745 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001746 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1747 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001748 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001749 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001750 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1751 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001752 break;
1753 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001754 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1755 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001756 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001757 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001758 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001759 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1760 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001761 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001762 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001763 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001764 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1765 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001766 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001767 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001768 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001769 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1770 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001771 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001772 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001773 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001774 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1775 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001776 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001777 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1778 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1779 Width = 128;
1780 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1781 break;
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00001782 case BuiltinType::Float16:
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001783 case BuiltinType::Half:
1784 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1785 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1786 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001787 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001788 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1789 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001790 break;
1791 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001792 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1793 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001794 break;
1795 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001796 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1797 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001798 break;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00001799 case BuiltinType::Float128:
1800 Width = Target->getFloat128Width();
1801 Align = Target->getFloat128Align();
1802 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001803 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001804 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1805 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001806 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001807 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1808 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1809 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001810 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1811 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001812 break;
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001813 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001814 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001815 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
1816 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00001817 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Yaxun Liu99444cb2016-08-03 20:38:06 +00001818#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
1819 case BuiltinType::Id:
1820#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Sven van Haastregt3bb7eaf2017-12-06 10:11:28 +00001821 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1822 Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T)));
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001823 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1824 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1825 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001826 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001827 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001828 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001829 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1830 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001831 break;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001832 case Type::BlockPointer:
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001833 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001834 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1835 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001836 break;
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001837 case Type::LValueReference:
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001838 case Type::RValueReference:
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001839 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1840 // the pointer route.
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001841 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001842 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1843 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001844 break;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001845 case Type::Pointer:
Sven van Haastregtefb4d4c2017-08-15 09:38:18 +00001846 AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001847 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1848 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001849 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001850 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001851 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Erich Keane8a6b7402017-11-30 16:37:02 +00001852 CXXABI::MemberPointerInfo MPI = ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT);
1853 Width = MPI.Width;
1854 Align = MPI.Align;
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001855 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001856 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001857 case Type::Complex: {
1858 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1859 // size.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001860 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1861 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1862 Align = EltInfo.Align;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001863 break;
1864 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001865 case Type::ObjCObject:
1866 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001867 case Type::Adjusted:
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00001868 case Type::Decayed:
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00001869 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001870 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001871 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001872 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001873 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001874 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001875 break;
1876 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001877 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001878 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001879 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1880
1881 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001882 Width = 8;
1883 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001884 break;
1885 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001886
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00001887 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1888 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1889 TypeInfo Info =
1890 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1891 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1892 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1893 Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1894 }
1895 return Info;
1896 }
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001897
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001898 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001899 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1900 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001901 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001902 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
David Majnemer5821ff72015-02-03 08:49:29 +00001903 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001904 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001905 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001906
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001907 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001908 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1909 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001910
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00001911 case Type::Auto:
1912 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: {
1913 const DeducedType *A = cast<DeducedType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001914 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1915 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001916 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001917 }
1918
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001919 case Type::Paren:
1920 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1921
Manman Rene6be26c2016-09-13 17:25:08 +00001922 case Type::ObjCTypeParam:
1923 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
1924
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001925 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001926 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001927 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001928 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1929 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1930 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001931 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001932 Align = AttrAlign;
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001933 AlignIsRequired = true;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001934 } else {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001935 Align = Info.Align;
David Majnemer37bffb62014-08-04 05:11:01 +00001936 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1937 }
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001938 Width = Info.Width;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001939 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001940 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001941
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001942 case Type::Elaborated:
1943 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001944
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001945 case Type::Attributed:
1946 return getTypeInfo(
1947 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1948
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001949 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001950 // Start with the base type information.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001951 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1952 Width = Info.Width;
1953 Align = Info.Align;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001954
1955 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1956 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1957 // favorable to atomic operations:
1958 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1959 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1960 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1961 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1962
1963 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001964 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1965 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001966 }
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00001967 break;
1968
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001969 case Type::Pipe:
Anastasia Stulovab3398932017-06-05 11:27:03 +00001970 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global));
1971 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global));
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00001972 break;
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001973 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001974
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001975 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00001976 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001977}
1978
Alexey Bataev00396512015-07-02 03:40:19 +00001979unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1980 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1981 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1982 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1983 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1984 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1985 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1986 SimdAlign = 256;
1987 return SimdAlign;
1988}
1989
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001990/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1991CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1992 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1993}
1994
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001995/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1996int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1997 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1998}
1999
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00002000/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
2001/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002002CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00002003 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00002004}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002005CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Richard Trieu04d2d942013-05-14 21:59:17 +00002006 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00002007}
2008
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00002009/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00002010/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002011CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00002012 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00002013}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002014CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00002015 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00002016}
2017
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00002018/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
2019/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
2020/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
2021/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002022unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00002023 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
2024 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002025
David Majnemere1544562015-04-24 01:25:05 +00002026 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
2027
2028 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
2029 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
2030 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
2031
Andrey Turetskiydb6655f2016-02-10 11:58:46 +00002032 if (!Target->allowsLargerPreferedTypeAlignment())
2033 return ABIAlign;
Robert Lyttoneaf6f362013-11-12 10:09:34 +00002034
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002035 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
David Majnemer1d4db8f2014-02-24 23:43:27 +00002036 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002037 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
David Majnemer475b25e2015-01-21 10:54:38 +00002038 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
2039 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002040 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00002041 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
2042 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00002043 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
2044 // typedef declaration.
David Majnemer34b57492014-07-30 01:30:47 +00002045 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
David Majnemer8b6bd572014-02-24 23:34:17 +00002046 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00002047
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00002048 return ABIAlign;
2049}
2050
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00002051/// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
2052/// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
2053/// value is specified.
Eugene Zelenkod4304d22015-11-04 21:37:17 +00002054unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned() const {
Ulrich Weigandca3cb7f2015-04-21 17:29:35 +00002055 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
2056}
2057
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00002058/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
2059/// to a global variable of the specified type.
2060unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
2061 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
2062}
2063
2064/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
2065/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
2066CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
2067 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
2068}
2069
David Majnemer08ef2ba2015-06-23 20:34:18 +00002070CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
2071 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
2072 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2073 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
2074 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
2075 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
2076 }
2077 return Offset;
2078}
2079
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002080/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
2081/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
2082/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
2083/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
2084/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002085void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
2086 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00002087 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00002088 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
2089 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
2090 if (!leafClass) {
Aaron Ballman59abbd42014-03-13 21:09:43 +00002091 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
2092 Ivars.push_back(I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00002093 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00002094 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00002095 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00002096 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
2097 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
2098 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00002099}
2100
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002101/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
2102/// those inherited by it.
2103void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00002104 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002105 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00002106 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
2107 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
Aaron Ballmana9f49e32014-03-13 20:55:22 +00002108 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002109 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00002110 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002111
2112 // Categories of this Interface.
Aaron Ballman3fe486a2014-03-13 21:23:55 +00002113 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
2114 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002115
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002116 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
2117 while (SD) {
2118 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
2119 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
2120 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002121 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Aaron Ballman19a41762014-03-14 12:55:57 +00002122 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002123 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002124 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002125 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00002126 // Insert the protocol.
2127 if (!Protocols.insert(
2128 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
2129 return;
2130
2131 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
2132 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00002133 }
2134}
2135
Erich Keane8a6b7402017-11-30 16:37:02 +00002136static bool unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2137 const RecordDecl *RD) {
2138 assert(RD->isUnion() && "Must be union type");
2139 CharUnits UnionSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(RD->getTypeForDecl());
2140
2141 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
2142 if (!Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType()))
2143 return false;
2144 CharUnits FieldSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType());
2145 if (FieldSize != UnionSize)
2146 return false;
2147 }
2148 return true;
2149}
2150
2151bool isStructEmpty(QualType Ty) {
2152 const RecordDecl *RD = Ty->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
2153
2154 if (!RD->field_empty())
2155 return false;
2156
2157 if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
2158 return ClassDecl->isEmpty();
2159
2160 return true;
2161}
2162
2163static llvm::Optional<int64_t>
2164structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(const ASTContext &Context,
2165 const RecordDecl *RD) {
2166 assert(!RD->isUnion() && "Must be struct/class type");
2167 const auto &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2168
2169 int64_t CurOffsetInBits = 0;
2170 if (const auto *ClassDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
2171 if (ClassDecl->isDynamicClass())
2172 return llvm::None;
2173
2174 SmallVector<std::pair<QualType, int64_t>, 4> Bases;
2175 for (const auto Base : ClassDecl->bases()) {
2176 // Empty types can be inherited from, and non-empty types can potentially
2177 // have tail padding, so just make sure there isn't an error.
2178 if (!isStructEmpty(Base.getType())) {
2179 llvm::Optional<int64_t> Size = structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(
2180 Context, Base.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
2181 if (!Size)
2182 return llvm::None;
2183 Bases.emplace_back(Base.getType(), Size.getValue());
2184 }
2185 }
2186
2187 std::sort(
2188 Bases.begin(), Bases.end(), [&](const std::pair<QualType, int64_t> &L,
2189 const std::pair<QualType, int64_t> &R) {
2190 return Layout.getBaseClassOffset(L.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) <
2191 Layout.getBaseClassOffset(R.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl());
2192 });
2193
2194 for (const auto Base : Bases) {
2195 int64_t BaseOffset = Context.toBits(
2196 Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base.first->getAsCXXRecordDecl()));
2197 int64_t BaseSize = Base.second;
2198 if (BaseOffset != CurOffsetInBits)
2199 return llvm::None;
2200 CurOffsetInBits = BaseOffset + BaseSize;
2201 }
2202 }
2203
2204 for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
2205 if (!Field->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
2206 !Context.hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(Field->getType()))
2207 return llvm::None;
2208
2209 int64_t FieldSizeInBits =
2210 Context.toBits(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(Field->getType()));
2211 if (Field->isBitField()) {
2212 int64_t BitfieldSize = Field->getBitWidthValue(Context);
2213
2214 if (BitfieldSize > FieldSizeInBits)
2215 return llvm::None;
2216 FieldSizeInBits = BitfieldSize;
2217 }
2218
2219 int64_t FieldOffsetInBits = Context.getFieldOffset(Field);
2220
2221 if (FieldOffsetInBits != CurOffsetInBits)
2222 return llvm::None;
2223
2224 CurOffsetInBits = FieldSizeInBits + FieldOffsetInBits;
2225 }
2226
2227 return CurOffsetInBits;
2228}
2229
2230bool ASTContext::hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(QualType Ty) const {
2231 // C++17 [meta.unary.prop]:
2232 // The predicate condition for a template specialization
2233 // has_unique_object_representations<T> shall be
2234 // satisfied if and only if:
2235 // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable, and
2236 // (9.2) - any two objects of type T with the same value have the same
2237 // object representation, where two objects
2238 // of array or non-union class type are considered to have the same value
2239 // if their respective sequences of
2240 // direct subobjects have the same values, and two objects of union type
2241 // are considered to have the same
2242 // value if they have the same active member and the corresponding members
2243 // have the same value.
2244 // The set of scalar types for which this condition holds is
2245 // implementation-defined. [ Note: If a type has padding
2246 // bits, the condition does not hold; otherwise, the condition holds true
2247 // for unsigned integral types. -- end note ]
2248 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "Null QualType sent to unique object rep check");
2249
2250 // Arrays are unique only if their element type is unique.
2251 if (Ty->isArrayType())
2252 return hasUniqueObjectRepresentations(getBaseElementType(Ty));
2253
2254 // (9.1) - T is trivially copyable...
2255 if (!Ty.isTriviallyCopyableType(*this))
2256 return false;
2257
2258 // All integrals and enums are unique.
2259 if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
2260 return true;
2261
2262 // All other pointers are unique.
2263 if (Ty->isPointerType())
2264 return true;
2265
2266 if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
2267 const MemberPointerType *MPT = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2268 return !ABI->getMemberPointerInfo(MPT).HasPadding;
2269 }
2270
2271 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
2272 const RecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
2273
Erich Keanebd2197c2017-12-12 16:02:06 +00002274 if (Record->isInvalidDecl())
2275 return false;
2276
Erich Keane8a6b7402017-11-30 16:37:02 +00002277 if (Record->isUnion())
2278 return unionHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record);
2279
2280 Optional<int64_t> StructSize =
2281 structHasUniqueObjectRepresentations(*this, Record);
2282
2283 return StructSize &&
2284 StructSize.getValue() == static_cast<int64_t>(getTypeSize(Ty));
2285 }
2286
2287 // FIXME: More cases to handle here (list by rsmith):
2288 // vectors (careful about, eg, vector of 3 foo)
2289 // _Complex int and friends
2290 // _Atomic T
2291 // Obj-C block pointers
2292 // Obj-C object pointers
2293 // and perhaps OpenCL's various builtin types (pipe, sampler_t, event_t,
2294 // clk_event_t, queue_t, reserve_id_t)
2295 // There're also Obj-C class types and the Obj-C selector type, but I think it
2296 // makes sense for those to return false here.
2297
2298 return false;
2299}
2300
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002301unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002302 unsigned count = 0;
2303 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Aaron Ballmanb4a53452014-03-13 21:57:01 +00002304 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002305 count += Ext->ivar_size();
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00002306
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00002307 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
2308 // includes synthesized ivars.
2309 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00002310 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
2311
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00002312 return count;
2313}
2314
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00002315bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
2316 if (!E)
2317 return false;
2318
2319 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
2320 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
2321
2322 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
2323 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
2324 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2325 return true;
2326
2327 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
2328 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
2329
2330 return false;
2331}
2332
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002333/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl, or nullptr if none
2334/// exists.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002335ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
2336 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2337 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2338 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2339 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002340 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002341}
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002342
2343/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or nullptr if none
2344/// exists.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002345ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
2346 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
2347 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
2348 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
2349 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002350 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002351}
2352
2353/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
2354void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
2355 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
2356 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2357 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2358}
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002359
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00002360/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
2361void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2362 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2363 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2364 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2365}
2366
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00002367const ObjCMethodDecl *
2368ASTContext::getObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) const {
2369 return ObjCMethodRedecls.lookup(MD);
2370}
2371
2372void ASTContext::setObjCMethodRedeclaration(const ObjCMethodDecl *MD,
2373 const ObjCMethodDecl *Redecl) {
2374 assert(!getObjCMethodRedeclaration(MD) && "MD already has a redeclaration");
2375 ObjCMethodRedecls[MD] = Redecl;
2376}
2377
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002378const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2379 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2380 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2381 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002382 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002383 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2384 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002385 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00002386 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2387 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002388 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2389
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002390 return nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00002391}
2392
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00002393/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl, or nullptr if
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002394/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002395Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002396 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2397 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2398 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00002399 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002400 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002401 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002402}
2403
2404/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
2405void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2406 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00002407 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2408 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00002409 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2410}
2411
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002412TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002413 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002414 if (!DataSize)
2415 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2416 else
2417 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002418 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00002419
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002420 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2421 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2422 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2423 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00002424}
2425
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002426TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00002427 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002428 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00002429 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00002430 return DI;
2431}
2432
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002433const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002434ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002435 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002436}
2437
2438const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002439ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2440 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00002441 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2442}
2443
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002444//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2445// Type creation/memoization methods
2446//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2447
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002448QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002449ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2450 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2451 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002452
2453 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2454 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002455 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002456 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002457 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2458 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2459 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002460 }
2461
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002462 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2463 QualType canon;
2464 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2465 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002466 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2467 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002468
2469 // Re-find the insert position.
2470 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2471 }
2472
2473 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2474 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2475 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002476}
2477
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00002478QualType ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T,
2479 LangAS AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002480 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2481 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00002482 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002483
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002484 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2485 // into one ExtQuals node.
2486 QualifierCollector Quals;
2487 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002488
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002489 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2490 // another one.
2491 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2492 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2493 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002494
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002495 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002496}
2497
Andrew Gozillon572bbb02017-10-02 06:25:51 +00002498QualType ASTContext::removeAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T) const {
2499 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2500 // into one ExtQuals node.
2501 QualifierCollector Quals;
2502 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2503
2504 // If the qualifier doesn't have an address space just return it.
2505 if (!Quals.hasAddressSpace())
2506 return T;
2507
2508 Quals.removeAddressSpace();
2509
2510 // Removal of the address space can mean there are no longer any
2511 // non-fast qualifiers, so creating an ExtQualType isn't possible (asserts)
2512 // or required.
2513 if (Quals.hasNonFastQualifiers())
2514 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
2515 else
2516 return QualType(TypeNode, Quals.getFastQualifiers());
2517}
2518
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002519QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002520 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002521 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002522 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002523 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002524
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002525 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2526 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002527 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002528 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2529 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2530 }
2531 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002532
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002533 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2534 // into one ExtQuals node.
2535 QualifierCollector Quals;
2536 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002537
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002538 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2539 // another one.
2540 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2541 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2542 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002543
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002544 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002545}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002546
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002547const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2548 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2549 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2550 return T;
2551
2552 QualType Result;
2553 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002554 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002555 } else {
2556 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2557 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2558 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00002559 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002560 }
2561
2562 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2563}
2564
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002565void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2566 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002567 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2568 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002569 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2570 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00002571 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002572 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2573 FD = Next;
2574 else
2575 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002576 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002577 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2578 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002579}
2580
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002581/// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2582/// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2583/// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2584/// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2585static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2586 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2587 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2588 // Might have some parens.
2589 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2590 return Context.getParenType(
2591 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2592
2593 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2594 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2595 return Context.getAttributedType(
2596 AT->getAttrKind(),
2597 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2598 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2599 ESI));
2600
2601 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2602 // specification.
2603 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2604 return Context.getFunctionType(
2605 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2606 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2607}
2608
Richard Smithdfe85e22016-12-15 02:35:39 +00002609bool ASTContext::hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(QualType T,
2610 QualType U) {
2611 return hasSameType(T, U) ||
Aaron Ballmanc351fba2017-12-04 20:27:34 +00002612 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
Richard Smithdfe85e22016-12-15 02:35:39 +00002613 hasSameType(getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, T, EST_None),
2614 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, U, EST_None)));
2615}
2616
Richard Smith0b3a4622014-11-13 20:01:57 +00002617void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2618 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2619 bool AsWritten) {
2620 // Update the type.
2621 QualType Updated =
2622 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2623 FD->setType(Updated);
2624
2625 if (!AsWritten)
2626 return;
2627
2628 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2629 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2630 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2631 // the type-as-written too.
2632 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2633 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2634
2635 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2636 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2637 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2638 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2639 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2640 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2641 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2642 }
2643}
2644
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002645/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2646/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002647QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002648 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2649 // structure.
2650 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2651 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002652
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002653 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002654 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2655 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002656
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002657 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2658 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2659 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002660 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002661 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002662
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002663 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2664 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002665 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002666 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002667 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002668 Types.push_back(New);
2669 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2670 return QualType(New, 0);
2671}
2672
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002673/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2674/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002675QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002676 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2677 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002678 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002679 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002680
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002681 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002682 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002683 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002684
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002685 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2686 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002687 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002688 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002689 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002690
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002691 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2692 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002693 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002694 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002695 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002696 Types.push_back(New);
2697 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002698 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002699}
2700
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002701QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2702 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2703 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002704 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002705 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2706 if (AT)
2707 return QualType(AT, 0);
2708
2709 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2710
2711 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2712 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002713 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002714
2715 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2716 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2717 Types.push_back(AT);
2718 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2719 return QualType(AT, 0);
2720}
2721
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002722QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2723 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2724
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002725 QualType Decayed;
2726
2727 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2728 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2729 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2730 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2731 // the array type derivation.
2732 if (T->isArrayType())
2733 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2734
2735 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2736 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2737 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2738 // in 6.3.2.1.
2739 if (T->isFunctionType())
2740 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2741
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002742 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2743 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002744 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002745 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2746 if (AT)
2747 return QualType(AT, 0);
2748
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002749 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2750
2751 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002752 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002753 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002754
Reid Kleckner0503a872013-12-05 01:23:43 +00002755 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2756 Types.push_back(AT);
2757 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2758 return QualType(AT, 0);
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00002759}
2760
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002761/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002762/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002763QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002764 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2765 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002766 // structure.
2767 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2768 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002769
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002770 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002771 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2772 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2773 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002774
2775 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002776 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2777 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002778 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002779 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002780
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002781 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2782 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2783 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002784 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002785 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002786 BlockPointerType *New
2787 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002788 Types.push_back(New);
2789 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2790 return QualType(New, 0);
2791}
2792
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002793/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2794/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002795QualType
2796ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002797 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2798 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2799
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002800 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2801 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002802 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002803 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002804
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002805 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002806 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2807 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002808 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002809
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002810 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2811
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002812 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2813 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2814 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002815 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2816 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2817 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002818
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002819 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002820 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2821 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002822 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002823 }
2824
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002825 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002826 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2827 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002828 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002829 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002830
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002831 return QualType(New, 0);
2832}
2833
2834/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2835/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002836QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002837 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2838 // structure.
2839 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002840 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002841
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002842 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002843 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2844 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2845 return QualType(RT, 0);
2846
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002847 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2848
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002849 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2850 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2851 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002852 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2853 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2854 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002855
2856 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2857 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2858 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002859 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002860 }
2861
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002862 RValueReferenceType *New
2863 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002864 Types.push_back(New);
2865 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002866 return QualType(New, 0);
2867}
2868
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002869/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2870/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002871QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002872 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2873 // structure.
2874 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2875 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2876
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002877 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002878 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2879 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2880 return QualType(PT, 0);
2881
2882 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2883 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2884 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002885 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002886 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2887
2888 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2889 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2890 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002891 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002892 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002893 MemberPointerType *New
2894 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002895 Types.push_back(New);
2896 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2897 return QualType(New, 0);
2898}
2899
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002900/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002901/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002902QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002903 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002904 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002905 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002906 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2907 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002908 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2909
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002910 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2911 // the target.
2912 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Konstantin Zhuravlyov9c1e3102017-03-21 18:55:39 +00002913 ArySize = ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getMaxPointerWidth());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002914
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002915 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002916 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002917
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002918 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002919 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002920 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002921 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002922
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002923 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2924 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2925 QualType Canon;
2926 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2927 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002928 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002929 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002930 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002931
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002932 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002933 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002934 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00002935 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002936 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002937
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002938 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002939 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002940 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002941 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002942 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002943}
2944
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002945/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2946/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2947/// sizes replaced with [*].
2948QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2949 // Vastly most common case.
2950 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002951
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002952 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002953
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002954 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002955 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002956 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2957#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2958#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2959#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2960#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2961 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2962
2963 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2964 case Type::Builtin:
2965 case Type::Complex:
2966 case Type::Vector:
2967 case Type::ExtVector:
2968 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
Andrew Gozillon572bbb02017-10-02 06:25:51 +00002969 case Type::DependentAddressSpace:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002970 case Type::ObjCObject:
2971 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2972 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2973 case Type::Record:
2974 case Type::Enum:
2975 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2976 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2977 case Type::TypeOf:
2978 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002979 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002980 case Type::DependentName:
2981 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2982 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2983 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2984 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2985 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002986 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00002987 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002988 case Type::PackExpansion:
2989 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2990
2991 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2992 // further decay.
2993 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2994 case Type::FunctionProto:
2995 case Type::BlockPointer:
2996 case Type::MemberPointer:
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00002997 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002998 return type;
2999
3000 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
3001 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
3002 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
3003 // optimizations available here.
3004 case Type::Pointer:
3005 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
3006 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
3007 break;
3008
3009 case Type::LValueReference: {
3010 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
3011 result = getLValueReferenceType(
3012 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
3013 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
3014 break;
3015 }
3016
3017 case Type::RValueReference: {
3018 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
3019 result = getRValueReferenceType(
3020 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
3021 break;
3022 }
3023
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003024 case Type::Atomic: {
3025 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
3026 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
3027 break;
3028 }
3029
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003030 case Type::ConstantArray: {
3031 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
3032 result = getConstantArrayType(
3033 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
3034 cat->getSize(),
3035 cat->getSizeModifier(),
3036 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
3037 break;
3038 }
3039
3040 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
3041 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
3042 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
3043 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
3044 dat->getSizeExpr(),
3045 dat->getSizeModifier(),
3046 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3047 dat->getBracketsRange());
3048 break;
3049 }
3050
3051 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
3052 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
3053 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
3054 result = getVariableArrayType(
3055 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003056 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003057 ArrayType::Normal,
3058 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3059 SourceRange());
3060 break;
3061 }
3062
3063 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
3064 case Type::VariableArray: {
3065 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
3066 result = getVariableArrayType(
3067 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003068 /*size*/ nullptr,
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003069 ArrayType::Star,
3070 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3071 vat->getBracketsRange());
3072 break;
3073 }
3074 }
3075
3076 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003077 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00003078}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003079
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00003080/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
3081/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00003082QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
3083 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00003084 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00003085 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003086 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003087 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
3088 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003089 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00003090
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003091 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
3092 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
3093 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003094 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00003095 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003096 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00003097 }
3098
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003099 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00003100 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003101
3102 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
3103 Types.push_back(New);
3104 return QualType(New, 0);
3105}
3106
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003107/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
3108/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00003109/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003110QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
3111 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003112 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003113 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
3114 SourceRange brackets) const {
3115 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
3116 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003117 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
3118
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003119 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
3120 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
3121 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
3122 // because they can't be used in most locations.
3123 if (!numElements) {
3124 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
3125 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3126 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
3127 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
3128 brackets);
3129 Types.push_back(newType);
3130 return QualType(newType, 0);
3131 }
3132
3133 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
3134 // also build a canonical type.
3135
3136 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
3137
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003138 void *insertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003139 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003140 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003141 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003142 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00003143
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003144 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
3145 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
3146 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00003147
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003148 // If we don't have one, build one.
3149 if (!canonTy) {
3150 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003151 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003152 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
3153 brackets);
3154 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
3155 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00003156 }
3157
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003158 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
3159 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003160 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003161
David Majnemer16a74702015-07-24 05:54:19 +00003162 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type or the size
3163 // expression, then just use that as our result.
3164 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType &&
3165 canonTy->getSizeExpr() == numElements)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003166 return canon;
3167
3168 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
3169 // of the element type.
3170 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
3171 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3172 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
3173 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
3174 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
3175 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00003176}
3177
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003178QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003179 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003180 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003181 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003182 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003183
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003184 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003185 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
3186 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
3187 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003188
3189 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003190 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
3191 // qualifiers off the element type.
3192 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003193
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003194 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
3195 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003196 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003197 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003198 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003199
3200 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003201 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
3202 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
3203 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00003204 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003205
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003206 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3207 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00003208
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003209 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
3210 Types.push_back(newType);
3211 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00003212}
3213
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003214/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
3215/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00003216QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003217 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00003218 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003219
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003220 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3221 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003222 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00003223
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003224 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003225 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3226 return QualType(VTP, 0);
3227
3228 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3229 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3230 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00003231 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00003232 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003233
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003234 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3235 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003236 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003237 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003238 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003239 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00003240 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3241 Types.push_back(New);
3242 return QualType(New, 0);
3243}
3244
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00003245/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003246/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003247QualType
3248ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00003249 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003250
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003251 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
3252 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00003253 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00003254 VectorType::GenericVector);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003255 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003256 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3257 return QualType(VTP, 0);
3258
3259 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
3260 // so fill in the canonical type field.
3261 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003262 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00003263 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003264
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003265 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3266 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003267 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003268 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003269 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3270 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00003271 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3272 Types.push_back(New);
3273 return QualType(New, 0);
3274}
3275
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003276QualType
3277ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
3278 Expr *SizeExpr,
3279 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003280 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003281 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003282 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003283
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003284 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003285 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
3286 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3287 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
3288 if (Canon) {
3289 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
3290 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003291 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3292 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
3293 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003294 } else {
3295 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
3296 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003297 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3298 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
3299 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003300
3301 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
3302 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3303 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
3304 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003305 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3306 } else {
3307 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
3308 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003309 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3310 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00003311 }
3312 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003313
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00003314 Types.push_back(New);
3315 return QualType(New, 0);
3316}
3317
Andrew Gozillon572bbb02017-10-02 06:25:51 +00003318QualType ASTContext::getDependentAddressSpaceType(QualType PointeeType,
3319 Expr *AddrSpaceExpr,
3320 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
3321 assert(AddrSpaceExpr->isInstantiationDependent());
3322
3323 QualType canonPointeeType = getCanonicalType(PointeeType);
3324
3325 void *insertPos = nullptr;
3326 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3327 DependentAddressSpaceType::Profile(ID, *this, canonPointeeType,
3328 AddrSpaceExpr);
3329
3330 DependentAddressSpaceType *canonTy =
3331 DependentAddressSpaceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
3332
3333 if (!canonTy) {
3334 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3335 DependentAddressSpaceType(*this, canonPointeeType,
3336 QualType(), AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc);
3337 DependentAddressSpaceTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
3338 Types.push_back(canonTy);
3339 }
3340
3341 if (canonPointeeType == PointeeType &&
3342 canonTy->getAddrSpaceExpr() == AddrSpaceExpr)
3343 return QualType(canonTy, 0);
3344
3345 DependentAddressSpaceType *sugaredType
3346 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3347 DependentAddressSpaceType(*this, PointeeType, QualType(canonTy, 0),
3348 AddrSpaceExpr, AttrLoc);
3349 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
3350 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
3351}
3352
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003353/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
3354static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
3355 return T.isCanonical() &&
3356 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
3357 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
3358}
3359
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003360/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003361QualType
3362ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
3363 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003364 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3365 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00003366 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00003367 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003368
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003369 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003370 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003371 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003372 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003373
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003374 QualType Canonical;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003375 if (!isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy)) {
3376 Canonical =
3377 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy), Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003378
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003379 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003380 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
3381 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003382 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003383 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003384
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003385 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003386 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, Info);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00003387 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003388 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003389 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003390}
3391
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003392CanQualType
3393ASTContext::getCanonicalFunctionResultType(QualType ResultType) const {
3394 CanQualType CanResultType = getCanonicalType(ResultType);
3395
3396 // Canonical result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
3397 if (CanResultType.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
3398 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultType.getQualifiers();
3399 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3400 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(
3401 getQualifiedType(CanResultType.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs));
3402 }
3403
3404 return CanResultType;
3405}
3406
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003407static bool isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(
3408 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI, bool NoexceptInType) {
3409 if (ESI.Type == EST_None)
3410 return true;
3411 if (!NoexceptInType)
3412 return false;
3413
3414 // C++17 onwards: exception specification is part of the type, as a simple
3415 // boolean "can this function type throw".
3416 if (ESI.Type == EST_BasicNoexcept)
3417 return true;
3418
3419 // A dynamic exception specification is canonical if it only contains pack
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003420 // expansions (so we can't tell whether it's non-throwing) and all its
3421 // contained types are canonical.
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003422 if (ESI.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
Richard Smithfda59e52016-10-26 01:05:54 +00003423 bool AnyPackExpansions = false;
3424 for (QualType ET : ESI.Exceptions) {
3425 if (!ET.isCanonical())
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003426 return false;
Richard Smithfda59e52016-10-26 01:05:54 +00003427 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
3428 AnyPackExpansions = true;
3429 }
3430 return AnyPackExpansions;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003431 }
3432
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003433 // A noexcept(expr) specification is (possibly) canonical if expr is
3434 // value-dependent.
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003435 if (ESI.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept)
3436 return ESI.NoexceptExpr && ESI.NoexceptExpr->isValueDependent();
3437
3438 return false;
3439}
3440
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003441QualType ASTContext::getFunctionTypeInternal(
3442 QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
3443 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI, bool OnlyWantCanonical) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003444 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
3445
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003446 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
3447 // structure.
3448 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3449 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
3450 *this, true);
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003451
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003452 QualType Canonical;
3453 bool Unique = false;
3454
3455 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3456 if (FunctionProtoType *FPT =
3457 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos)) {
3458 QualType Existing = QualType(FPT, 0);
3459
3460 // If we find a pre-existing equivalent FunctionProtoType, we can just reuse
3461 // it so long as our exception specification doesn't contain a dependent
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003462 // noexcept expression, or we're just looking for a canonical type.
3463 // Otherwise, we're going to need to create a type
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003464 // sugar node to hold the concrete expression.
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003465 if (OnlyWantCanonical || EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type != EST_ComputedNoexcept ||
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003466 EPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr == FPT->getNoexceptExpr())
3467 return Existing;
3468
3469 // We need a new type sugar node for this one, to hold the new noexcept
3470 // expression. We do no canonicalization here, but that's OK since we don't
3471 // expect to see the same noexcept expression much more than once.
3472 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Existing);
3473 Unique = true;
3474 }
3475
Aaron Ballmanc351fba2017-12-04 20:27:34 +00003476 bool NoexceptInType = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003477 bool IsCanonicalExceptionSpec =
3478 isCanonicalExceptionSpecification(EPI.ExceptionSpec, NoexceptInType);
3479
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003480 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003481 bool isCanonical = !Unique && IsCanonicalExceptionSpec &&
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003482 isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) && !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003483 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003484 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003485 isCanonical = false;
3486
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003487 if (OnlyWantCanonical)
3488 assert(isCanonical &&
3489 "given non-canonical parameters constructing canonical type");
3490
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003491 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it if we don't
3492 // already have it. The exception spec is only partially part of the
3493 // canonical type, and only in C++17 onwards.
3494 if (!isCanonical && Canonical.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003495 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003496 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3497 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003498 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003499
Benjamin Kramer3f515cd2016-10-26 12:51:45 +00003500 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ExceptionTypeStorage;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003501 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00003502 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003503
3504 if (IsCanonicalExceptionSpec) {
3505 // Exception spec is already OK.
3506 } else if (NoexceptInType) {
3507 switch (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type) {
3508 case EST_Unparsed: case EST_Unevaluated: case EST_Uninstantiated:
3509 // We don't know yet. It shouldn't matter what we pick here; no-one
3510 // should ever look at this.
3511 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003512 case EST_None: case EST_MSAny:
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003513 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3514 break;
3515
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003516 // A dynamic exception specification is almost always "not noexcept",
3517 // with the exception that a pack expansion might expand to no types.
3518 case EST_Dynamic: {
3519 bool AnyPacks = false;
3520 for (QualType ET : EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions) {
3521 if (ET->getAs<PackExpansionType>())
3522 AnyPacks = true;
3523 ExceptionTypeStorage.push_back(getCanonicalType(ET));
3524 }
3525 if (!AnyPacks)
3526 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3527 else {
3528 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_Dynamic;
3529 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions = ExceptionTypeStorage;
3530 }
3531 break;
3532 }
3533
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003534 case EST_DynamicNone: case EST_BasicNoexcept:
3535 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_BasicNoexcept;
3536 break;
3537
3538 case EST_ComputedNoexcept:
3539 llvm::APSInt Value(1);
3540 auto *E = CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.NoexceptExpr;
3541 if (!E || !E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Value, *this, nullptr,
3542 /*IsEvaluated*/false)) {
3543 // This noexcept specification is invalid.
3544 // FIXME: Should this be able to happen?
3545 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type = EST_None;
3546 break;
3547 }
3548
3549 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
3550 Value.getBoolValue() ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_None;
3551 break;
3552 }
Richard Smith3c4f8d22016-10-16 17:54:23 +00003553 } else {
3554 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
3555 }
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003556
Douglas Gregora602a152015-10-01 20:20:47 +00003557 // Adjust the canonical function result type.
3558 CanQualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalFunctionResultType(ResultTy);
Richard Smith304b1242016-10-18 20:13:25 +00003559 Canonical =
3560 getFunctionTypeInternal(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI, true);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003561
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00003562 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003563 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3564 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003565 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003566 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00003567
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003568 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3569 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3570 // - parameter types
3571 // - exception types
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003572 // - extended parameter information
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003573 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003574 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3575 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003576 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003577 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003578
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003579 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3580 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3581 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00003582 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003583 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00003584 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smith8acb4282014-07-31 21:57:55 +00003585 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00003586 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00003587 }
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00003588
3589 // Put the ExtParameterInfos last. If all were equal, it would make
3590 // more sense to put these before the exception specification, because
3591 // it's much easier to skip past them compared to the elaborate switch
3592 // required to skip the exception specification. However, all is not
3593 // equal; ExtParameterInfos are used to model very uncommon features,
3594 // and it's better not to burden the more common paths.
3595 if (EPI.ExtParameterInfos) {
3596 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo);
3597 }
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003598
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00003599 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00003600 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00003601 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003602 Types.push_back(FTP);
Richard Smith2a2cda52016-10-18 19:29:18 +00003603 if (!Unique)
3604 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003605 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00003606}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00003607
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003608QualType ASTContext::getPipeType(QualType T, bool ReadOnly) const {
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003609 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003610 PipeType::Profile(ID, T, ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003611
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00003612 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003613 if (PipeType *PT = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003614 return QualType(PT, 0);
3615
3616 // If the pipe element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3617 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3618 QualType Canonical;
3619 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003620 Canonical = getPipeType(getCanonicalType(T), ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003621
3622 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003623 PipeType *NewIP = PipeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003624 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
3625 (void)NewIP;
3626 }
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003627 PipeType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PipeType(T, Canonical, ReadOnly);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003628 Types.push_back(New);
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003629 PipeTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00003630 return QualType(New, 0);
3631}
3632
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003633QualType ASTContext::getReadPipeType(QualType T) const {
3634 return getPipeType(T, true);
3635}
3636
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00003637QualType ASTContext::getWritePipeType(QualType T) const {
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00003638 return getPipeType(T, false);
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00003639}
3640
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003641#ifndef NDEBUG
3642static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3643 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3644 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3645 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3646 return true;
3647 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3648 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3649 return true;
3650 return false;
3651}
3652#endif
3653
3654/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3655/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3656QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003657 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003658 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3659 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3660 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003661 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003662 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3663 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3664 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3665 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003666 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003667 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003668 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3669 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003670 }
3671 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3672}
3673
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003674/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3675/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003676QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00003677 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003678 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003679
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003680 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003681 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003682
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003683 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3684 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3685
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003686 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003687 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003688 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003689 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003690 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Rafael Espindola3f9e4442013-10-19 02:13:21 +00003691 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003692 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00003693 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00003694 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003695 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3696 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3697 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00003698 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00003699 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003700
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00003701 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00003702}
3703
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00003704/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003705/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003706QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00003707ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3708 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00003709 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003710
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003711 if (Canonical.isNull())
3712 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003713 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003714 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003715 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3716 Types.push_back(newType);
3717 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00003718}
3719
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003720QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003721 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3722
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003723 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003724 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3725 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3726
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003727 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3728 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3729 Types.push_back(newType);
3730 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003731}
3732
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003733QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003734 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3735
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00003736 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003737 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3738 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3739
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00003740 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3741 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3742 Types.push_back(newType);
3743 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00003744}
3745
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003746QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3747 QualType modifiedType,
3748 QualType equivalentType) {
3749 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3750 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3751
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003752 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00003753 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3754 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3755
3756 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3757 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3758 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3759
3760 Types.push_back(type);
3761 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3762
3763 return QualType(type, 0);
3764}
3765
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003766/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3767QualType
3768ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003769 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00003770 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003771 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3772
3773 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3774 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003775 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00003776 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3777 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3778
3779 if (!SubstParm) {
3780 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3781 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3782 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3783 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3784 }
3785
3786 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3787}
3788
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003789/// \brief Retrieve a
3790QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3791 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3792 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3793#ifndef NDEBUG
Aaron Ballman2a89e852014-07-15 21:32:31 +00003794 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3795 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3796 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003797 }
3798#endif
3799
3800 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3801 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003802 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003803 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3804 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3805 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3806
3807 QualType Canon;
3808 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3809 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3810 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3811 ArgPack);
3812 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3813 }
3814
3815 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3816 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3817 ArgPack);
3818 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
George Burgess IVb5fe8552017-06-12 17:44:30 +00003819 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00003820 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3821}
3822
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003823/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003824/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003825/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003826QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003827 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003828 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003829 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003830 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003831 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003832 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003833 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3834
3835 if (TypeParm)
3836 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003837
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003838 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003839 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003840 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003841
3842 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3843 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3844 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3845 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003846 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003847 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3848 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003849
3850 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3851 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3852
3853 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3854}
3855
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003856TypeSourceInfo *
3857ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3858 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3859 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003860 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003861 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3862 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003863 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003864
3865 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003866 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3867 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003868 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003869 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3870 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3871 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3872 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3873 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3874 return DI;
3875}
3876
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003877QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003878ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003879 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003880 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003881 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3882 "No dependent template names here!");
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003883
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003884 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003885 ArgVec.reserve(Args.size());
3886 for (const TemplateArgumentLoc &Arg : Args.arguments())
3887 ArgVec.push_back(Arg.getArgument());
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003888
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003889 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec, Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003890}
3891
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003892#ifndef NDEBUG
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003893static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) {
3894 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3895 if (Arg.isPackExpansion())
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003896 return true;
3897
3898 return true;
3899}
3900#endif
3901
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003902QualType
3903ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003904 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003905 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003906 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3907 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003908 // Look through qualified template names.
3909 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3910 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003911
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003912 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003913 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3914 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003915 QualType CanonType;
3916 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3917 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3918 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003919 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3920 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003921 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args)) &&
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003922 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3923 IsTypeAlias = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003924 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args);
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003925 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003926
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003927 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3928 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3929 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003930 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003931 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * Args.size() +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003932 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003933 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003934 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003935 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, CanonType,
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003936 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003937
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003938 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003939 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003940}
3941
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003942QualType ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(
3943 TemplateName Template, ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003944 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3945 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003946
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003947 // Look through qualified template names.
3948 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3949 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003950
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003951 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3952 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003953 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003954 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003955 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003956 for (const TemplateArgument &Arg : Args)
3957 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Arg));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003958
3959 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3960 // exists.
3961 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3962 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003963 CanonArgs, *this);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003964
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003965 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003966 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3967 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3968
3969 if (!Spec) {
3970 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3971 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3972 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3973 TypeAlignment);
3974 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00003975 CanonArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003976 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003977 Types.push_back(Spec);
3978 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3979 }
3980
3981 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3982 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3983 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3984}
3985
3986QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003987ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3988 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003989 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003990 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003991 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003992
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00003993 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003994 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003995 if (T)
3996 return QualType(T, 0);
3997
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003998 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3999 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
4000 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00004001 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4002 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004003 (void)CheckT;
4004 }
4005
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004006 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00004007 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00004008 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00004009 return QualType(T, 0);
4010}
4011
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004012QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004013ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004014 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4015 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
4016
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004017 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004018 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4019 if (T)
4020 return QualType(T, 0);
4021
4022 QualType Canon = InnerType;
4023 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
4024 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
4025 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4026 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
4027 (void)CheckT;
4028 }
4029
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004030 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00004031 Types.push_back(T);
4032 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4033 return QualType(T, 0);
4034}
4035
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00004036QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
4037 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
4038 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004039 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004040 if (Canon.isNull()) {
4041 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Richard Smith74f02342017-01-19 21:00:13 +00004042 if (CanonNNS != NNS)
4043 Canon = getDependentNameType(Keyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004044 }
4045
4046 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00004047 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004048
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004049 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00004050 DependentNameType *T
4051 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004052 if (T)
4053 return QualType(T, 0);
4054
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004055 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004056 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00004057 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004058 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004059}
4060
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004061QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004062ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
4063 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00004064 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004065 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004066 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004067 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00004068 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004069 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
4070 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004071 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name, ArgCopy);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004072}
4073
4074QualType
4075ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
4076 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
4077 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
4078 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004079 ArrayRef<TemplateArgument> Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00004080 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
4081 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004082
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004083 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004084 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004085 Name, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004086
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004087 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004088 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
4089 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004090 if (T)
4091 return QualType(T, 0);
4092
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004093 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00004094
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004095 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
4096 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
4097
4098 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004099 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00004100 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004101 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
4102 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
4103 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
4104 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004105 }
4106
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004107 QualType Canon;
4108 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
4109 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004110 Name,
4111 CanonArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004112
4113 // Find the insert position again.
4114 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4115 }
4116
4117 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
4118 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
4119 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00004120 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
David Majnemer6fbeee32016-07-07 04:43:07 +00004121 Name, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004122 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00004123 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004124 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00004125}
4126
Richard Smith32918772017-02-14 00:25:28 +00004127TemplateArgument ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArg(NamedDecl *Param) {
4128 TemplateArgument Arg;
4129 if (auto *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Param)) {
4130 QualType ArgType = getTypeDeclType(TTP);
4131 if (TTP->isParameterPack())
4132 ArgType = getPackExpansionType(ArgType, None);
4133
4134 Arg = TemplateArgument(ArgType);
4135 } else if (auto *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Param)) {
4136 Expr *E = new (*this) DeclRefExpr(
4137 NTTP, /*enclosing*/false,
4138 NTTP->getType().getNonLValueExprType(*this),
4139 Expr::getValueKindForType(NTTP->getType()), NTTP->getLocation());
4140
4141 if (NTTP->isParameterPack())
4142 E = new (*this) PackExpansionExpr(DependentTy, E, NTTP->getLocation(),
4143 None);
4144 Arg = TemplateArgument(E);
4145 } else {
4146 auto *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Param);
4147 if (TTP->isParameterPack())
4148 Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP), Optional<unsigned>());
4149 else
4150 Arg = TemplateArgument(TemplateName(TTP));
4151 }
4152
4153 if (Param->isTemplateParameterPack())
4154 Arg = TemplateArgument::CreatePackCopy(*this, Arg);
4155
4156 return Arg;
4157}
4158
Richard Smith43e14d22016-12-23 02:10:11 +00004159void
4160ASTContext::getInjectedTemplateArgs(const TemplateParameterList *Params,
4161 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateArgument> &Args) {
4162 Args.reserve(Args.size() + Params->size());
4163
Richard Smith32918772017-02-14 00:25:28 +00004164 for (NamedDecl *Param : *Params)
4165 Args.push_back(getInjectedTemplateArg(Param));
Richard Smith43e14d22016-12-23 02:10:11 +00004166}
4167
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00004168QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00004169 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004170 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00004171 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004172
4173 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
4174 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004175 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004176 PackExpansionType *T
4177 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4178 if (T)
4179 return QualType(T, 0);
4180
4181 QualType Canon;
4182 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00004183 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
4184 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
4185 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
4186 // parameters.
4187 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00004188 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004189
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00004190 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
4191 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
4192 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4193 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004194 }
4195
Benjamin Kramer8adeef92015-04-02 16:19:54 +00004196 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4197 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004198 Types.push_back(T);
4199 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8b4e1e22014-07-10 01:20:17 +00004200 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00004201}
4202
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004203/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
4204/// alphabetically.
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00004205static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
4206 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
4207 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004208}
4209
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00004210static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> Protocols) {
4211 if (Protocols.empty()) return true;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004212
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00004213 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
4214 return false;
4215
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00004216 for (unsigned i = 1; i != Protocols.size(); ++i)
Benjamin Kramer0eb262f2015-03-14 13:32:49 +00004217 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00004218 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004219 return false;
4220 return true;
4221}
4222
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004223static void
4224SortAndUniqueProtocols(SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &Protocols) {
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004225 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004226 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end(), CmpProtocolNames);
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004227
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00004228 // Canonicalize.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004229 for (ObjCProtocolDecl *&P : Protocols)
4230 P = P->getCanonicalDecl();
4231
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004232 // Remove duplicates.
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004233 auto ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols.begin(), Protocols.end());
4234 Protocols.erase(ProtocolsEnd, Protocols.end());
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004235}
4236
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004237QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
4238 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004239 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004240 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, {},
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004241 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
4242 /*isKindOf=*/false);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004243}
4244
4245QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
4246 QualType baseType,
4247 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004248 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
4249 bool isKindOf) const {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004250 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
4251 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004252 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
4253 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004254 return baseType;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004255
4256 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004257 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004258 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004259 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004260 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4261 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004262
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004263 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
4264 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
4265 // type.
4266 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
4267 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
4268 if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
4269 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
4270 }
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004271
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004272 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
4273 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
4274 // canonicalized.
4275 QualType canonical;
4276 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
4277 effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
4278 [&](QualType type) {
4279 return type.isCanonical();
4280 });
Craig Topper1f26d5b2016-01-03 19:43:23 +00004281 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004282 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
4283 // Determine the canonical type arguments.
4284 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
4285 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
4286 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
4287 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
4288 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
4289 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
4290 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004291 } else {
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004292 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004293 }
4294
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004295 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
4296 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
4297 if (!protocolsSorted) {
Craig Topper6a8c1512015-10-22 01:56:18 +00004298 canonProtocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
4299 SortAndUniqueProtocols(canonProtocolsVec);
4300 canonProtocols = canonProtocolsVec;
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004301 } else {
4302 canonProtocols = protocols;
4303 }
4304
4305 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004306 canonProtocols, isKindOf);
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004307
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004308 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004309 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4310 }
4311
Douglas Gregore9d95f12015-07-07 03:57:35 +00004312 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
4313 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
4314 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
4315 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004316 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00004317 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
4318 isKindOf);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004319
4320 Types.push_back(T);
4321 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
4322 return QualType(T, 0);
4323}
4324
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004325/// Apply Objective-C protocol qualifiers to the given type.
4326/// If this is for the canonical type of a type parameter, we can apply
4327/// protocol qualifiers on the ObjCObjectPointerType.
4328QualType
4329ASTContext::applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(QualType type,
4330 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols, bool &hasError,
4331 bool allowOnPointerType) const {
4332 hasError = false;
4333
Manman Renc5705ba2016-09-13 17:41:05 +00004334 if (const ObjCTypeParamType *objT =
4335 dyn_cast<ObjCTypeParamType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
4336 return getObjCTypeParamType(objT->getDecl(), protocols);
4337 }
4338
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004339 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectPointerType.
4340 if (allowOnPointerType) {
4341 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr =
4342 dyn_cast<ObjCObjectPointerType>(type.getTypePtr())) {
4343 const ObjCObjectType *objT = objPtr->getObjectType();
4344 // Merge protocol lists and construct ObjCObjectType.
4345 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> protocolsVec;
4346 protocolsVec.append(objT->qual_begin(),
4347 objT->qual_end());
4348 protocolsVec.append(protocols.begin(), protocols.end());
4349 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols = protocolsVec;
4350 type = getObjCObjectType(
4351 objT->getBaseType(),
4352 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
4353 protocols,
4354 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
4355 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4356 }
4357 }
4358
4359 // Apply protocol qualifiers to ObjCObjectType.
4360 if (const ObjCObjectType *objT = dyn_cast<ObjCObjectType>(type.getTypePtr())){
4361 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
4362 // known to conform.
4363
4364 return getObjCObjectType(objT->getBaseType(),
4365 objT->getTypeArgsAsWritten(),
4366 protocols,
4367 objT->isKindOfTypeAsWritten());
4368 }
4369
4370 // If the canonical type is ObjCObjectType, ...
4371 if (type->isObjCObjectType()) {
4372 // Silently overwrite any existing protocol qualifiers.
4373 // TODO: determine whether that's the right thing to do.
4374
4375 // FIXME: Check for protocols to which the class type is already
4376 // known to conform.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004377 return getObjCObjectType(type, {}, protocols, false);
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004378 }
4379
4380 // id<protocol-list>
4381 if (type->isObjCIdType()) {
4382 const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004383 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, protocols,
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004384 objPtr->isKindOfType());
4385 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4386 }
4387
4388 // Class<protocol-list>
4389 if (type->isObjCClassType()) {
4390 const ObjCObjectPointerType *objPtr = type->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004391 type = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, protocols,
Manman Ren3569eb52016-09-13 17:03:12 +00004392 objPtr->isKindOfType());
4393 return getObjCObjectPointerType(type);
4394 }
4395
4396 hasError = true;
4397 return type;
4398}
4399
Manman Rene6be26c2016-09-13 17:25:08 +00004400QualType
4401ASTContext::getObjCTypeParamType(const ObjCTypeParamDecl *Decl,
4402 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
4403 QualType Canonical) const {
4404 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4405 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4406 ObjCTypeParamType::Profile(ID, Decl, protocols);
4407 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4408 if (ObjCTypeParamType *TypeParam =
4409 ObjCTypeParamTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4410 return QualType(TypeParam, 0);
4411
4412 if (Canonical.isNull()) {
4413 // We canonicalize to the underlying type.
4414 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
4415 if (!protocols.empty()) {
4416 // Apply the protocol qualifers.
4417 bool hasError;
4418 Canonical = applyObjCProtocolQualifiers(Canonical, protocols, hasError,
4419 true/*allowOnPointerType*/);
4420 assert(!hasError && "Error when apply protocol qualifier to bound type");
4421 }
4422 }
4423
4424 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCTypeParamType);
4425 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
4426 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
4427 ObjCTypeParamType *newType = new (mem)
4428 ObjCTypeParamType(Decl, Canonical, protocols);
4429
4430 Types.push_back(newType);
4431 ObjCTypeParamTypes.InsertNode(newType, InsertPos);
4432 return QualType(newType, 0);
4433}
4434
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004435/// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
4436/// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
4437/// list.
4438bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
4439 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
4440 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4441 return false;
4442
4443 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
4444 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004445 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004446 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
4447 return false;
4448 }
4449 return true;
4450 }
4451 return false;
4452}
4453
4454/// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
4455/// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
4456/// of protocols.
4457bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
4458 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
4459 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4460 return false;
4461 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4462 if (!OPT)
4463 return false;
4464 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
4465 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00004466 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
4467 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
4468 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
4469 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00004470 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
4471 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
4472 bool Conforms = false;
4473 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
4474 Conforms = false;
4475 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
4476 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
4477 Conforms = true;
4478 break;
4479 }
4480 }
4481 if (!Conforms)
4482 break;
4483 }
4484 if (Conforms)
4485 return true;
4486
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004487 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004488 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
4489 bool Adopts = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004490 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48a01cb2014-04-04 23:53:45 +00004491 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00004492 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004493 break;
4494 }
4495 if (!Adopts)
Fariborz Jahanian91fb0be2013-11-20 19:01:50 +00004496 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian92ab2982013-11-20 00:32:12 +00004497 }
4498 return true;
4499}
4500
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004501/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
4502/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004503QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004504 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4505 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
4506
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004507 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004508 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
4509 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4510 return QualType(QT, 0);
4511
4512 // Find the canonical object type.
4513 QualType Canonical;
4514 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
4515 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
4516
4517 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004518 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4519 }
4520
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00004521 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004522 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
4523 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
4524 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004525
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004526 Types.push_back(QType);
4527 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00004528 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00004529}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00004530
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004531/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4532/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00004533QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
4534 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004535 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
4536 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004537
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00004538 if (PrevDecl) {
4539 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
4540 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
4541 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
4542 }
4543
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00004544 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
4545 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
4546 Decl = Def;
4547
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00004548 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
4549 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
4550 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
4551 Types.push_back(T);
4552 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00004553}
4554
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004555/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
4556/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004557/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004558/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004559/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004560QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004561 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004562 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
4563 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4564 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004565
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004566 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004567 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
4568 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4569 if (Canon) {
4570 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
4571 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004572 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004573 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00004574 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004575 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004576 Canon
4577 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00004578 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4579 toe = Canon;
4580 }
4581 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004582 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004583 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004584 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004585 Types.push_back(toe);
4586 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00004587}
4588
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004589/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004590/// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004591/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004592/// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
4593/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004594QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004595 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004596 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00004597 Types.push_back(tot);
4598 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00004599}
4600
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004601/// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
4602/// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
4603/// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
4604/// is an Expr tree under each such type.
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00004605QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004606 DecltypeType *dt;
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004607
4608 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00004609 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004610 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
4611 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00004612 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004613 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4614 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004615
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004616 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004617 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
4618 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004619 if (!Canon) {
Yaron Keren633e14a2016-11-29 10:08:20 +00004620 // Build a new, canonical decltype(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00004621 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004622 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004623 }
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004624 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4625 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00004626 } else {
Richard Smith8eb1d322014-06-05 20:13:13 +00004627 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4628 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00004629 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00004630 Types.push_back(dt);
4631 return QualType(dt, 0);
4632}
4633
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004634/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
4635/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
4636QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
4637 QualType UnderlyingType,
4638 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
4639 const {
Vassil Vassilevbab6f962016-03-30 22:18:29 +00004640 UnaryTransformType *ut = nullptr;
4641
4642 if (BaseType->isDependentType()) {
4643 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4644 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4645 DependentUnaryTransformType::Profile(ID, getCanonicalType(BaseType), Kind);
4646
4647 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4648 DependentUnaryTransformType *Canon
4649 = DependentUnaryTransformTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
4650
4651 if (!Canon) {
4652 // Build a new, canonical __underlying_type(type) type.
4653 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4654 DependentUnaryTransformType(*this, getCanonicalType(BaseType),
4655 Kind);
4656 DependentUnaryTransformTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
4657 }
4658 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4659 QualType(), Kind,
4660 QualType(Canon, 0));
4661 } else {
4662 QualType CanonType = getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType);
4663 ut = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType,
4664 UnderlyingType, Kind,
4665 CanonType);
4666 }
4667 Types.push_back(ut);
4668 return QualType(ut, 0);
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00004669}
4670
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004671/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
4672/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
4673/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004674QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, AutoTypeKeyword Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004675 bool IsDependent) const {
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004676 if (DeducedType.isNull() && Keyword == AutoTypeKeyword::Auto && !IsDependent)
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004677 return getAutoDeductType();
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004678
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004679 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004680 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004681 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004682 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, Keyword, IsDependent);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004683 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4684 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004685
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00004686 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004687 Keyword,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004688 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00004689 Types.push_back(AT);
4690 if (InsertPos)
4691 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
4692 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00004693}
4694
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00004695/// Return the uniqued reference to the deduced template specialization type
4696/// which has been deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced
4697/// such type, or the canonical deduced-but-dependent such type.
4698QualType ASTContext::getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(
4699 TemplateName Template, QualType DeducedType, bool IsDependent) const {
4700 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
4701 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
4702 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4703 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, Template, DeducedType,
4704 IsDependent);
4705 if (DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST =
4706 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4707 return QualType(DTST, 0);
4708
4709 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType *DTST = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
4710 DeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, DeducedType, IsDependent);
4711 Types.push_back(DTST);
4712 if (InsertPos)
4713 DeducedTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(DTST, InsertPos);
4714 return QualType(DTST, 0);
4715}
4716
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004717/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
4718/// the given value type.
4719QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
4720 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
4721 // structure.
4722 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
4723 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
4724
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004725 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004726 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
4727 return QualType(AT, 0);
4728
4729 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
4730 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
4731 QualType Canonical;
4732 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
4733 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
4734
4735 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
4736 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00004737 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00004738 }
4739 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
4740 Types.push_back(New);
4741 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
4742 return QualType(New, 0);
4743}
4744
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004745/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
4746QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
4747 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004748 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
Richard Smithe301ba22015-11-11 02:02:15 +00004749 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), AutoTypeKeyword::Auto,
Manuel Klimek2fdbea22013-08-22 12:12:24 +00004750 /*dependent*/false),
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00004751 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00004752 return AutoDeductTy;
4753}
4754
4755/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
4756QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
4757 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
4758 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
4759 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
4760 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
4761}
4762
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004763/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
4764/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004765QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00004766 assert(Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00004767 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
4768 // away const? mutable?
4769 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004770}
4771
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004772/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
4773/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
4774/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00004775CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004776 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00004777}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00004778
Alexander Shaposhnikov1e898d92017-07-14 17:30:14 +00004779/// Return the unique signed counterpart of the integer type
4780/// corresponding to size_t.
4781CanQualType ASTContext::getSignedSizeType() const {
4782 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSignedSizeType());
4783}
4784
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004785/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4786CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
4787 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
4788}
4789
4790/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
4791CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
4792 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
4793}
4794
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00004795/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
4796/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4797QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
4798 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4799 return WCharTy;
4800}
4801
4802/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
4803/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
4804QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
4805 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4806 return UnsignedIntTy;
4807}
4808
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00004809QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
4810 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
4811}
4812
4813QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
4814 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
4815}
4816
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00004817/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004818/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
4819QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00004820 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00004821}
4822
Alexander Shaposhnikov195b25c2017-09-28 23:11:31 +00004823/// \brief Return the unique unsigned counterpart of "ptrdiff_t"
4824/// integer type. The standard (C11 7.21.6.1p7) refers to this type
4825/// in the definition of %tu format specifier.
4826QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedPointerDiffType() const {
4827 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUnsignedPtrDiffType(0));
4828}
4829
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00004830/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4831/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
4832QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4833 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4834}
4835
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004836//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4837// Type Operators
4838//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4839
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004840CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004841 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4842 // qualifiers.
4843 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00004844 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004845 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00004846 QualType Result;
4847 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4848 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4849 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4850 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4851 } else {
4852 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4853 }
4854
4855 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4856}
4857
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004858QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4859 Qualifiers &quals) {
4860 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4861
4862 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4863 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4864 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4865 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4866 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004867 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004868
4869 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004870 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004871 quals = splitType.Quals;
4872 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004873 }
4874
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004875 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4876 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4877 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4878
4879 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4880 // can just use the results in splitType.
4881 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4882 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004883 quals = splitType.Quals;
4884 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004885 }
4886
4887 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4888 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004889 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004890
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004891 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004892 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004893 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4894 }
4895
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004896 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004897 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004898 }
4899
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004900 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004901 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004902 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00004903 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4904 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4905 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4906 }
4907
4908 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00004909 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00004910 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4911 SourceRange());
4912}
4913
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004914/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4915/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4916/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4917/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4918/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4919/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4920/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4921/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4922bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4923 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4924 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4925 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4926 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4927 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4928 return true;
4929 }
4930
4931 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4932 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4933 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4934 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4935 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4936 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4937 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4938 return true;
4939 }
4940
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004941 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00004942 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4943 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4944 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4945 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4946 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4947 return true;
4948 }
4949 }
4950
4951 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4952
4953 return false;
4954}
4955
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004956DeclarationNameInfo
4957ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4958 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004959 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4960 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4961 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004962 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004963 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4964 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004965
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004966 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4967 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4968 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4969 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4970 }
4971
4972 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4973 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004974 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004975 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004976 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4977 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004978 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00004979 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4980 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4981 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4982 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4983 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4984 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00004985 }
4986 }
4987
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00004988 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4989 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4990 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4991 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4992 NameLoc);
4993 }
4994
4995 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4996 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4997 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4998 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4999 NameLoc);
5000 }
5001 }
5002
5003 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00005004}
5005
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005006TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005007 switch (Name.getKind()) {
5008 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
5009 case TemplateName::Template: {
5010 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00005011 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005012 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00005013 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
5014
5015 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00005016 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00005017 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00005018
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005019 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
5020 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005021
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00005022 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
5023 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
5024 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
5025 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
5026 }
5027
5028 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
5029 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
5030 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
5031 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
5032 }
5033
5034 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
5035 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
5036 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
5037 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
5038 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
5039 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
5040 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
5041 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
5042 }
5043 }
5044
5045 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00005046}
5047
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00005048bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
5049 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
5050 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
5051 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
5052}
5053
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005054TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005055ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005056 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
5057 case TemplateArgument::Null:
5058 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005059
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005060 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005061 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005062
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00005063 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00005064 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
David Blaikie952a9b12014-10-17 18:00:12 +00005065 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00005066 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005067
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00005068 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
5069 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
5070 /*isNullPtr*/true);
5071
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00005072 case TemplateArgument::Template:
5073 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00005074
5075 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
5076 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
5077 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00005078 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00005079
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005080 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00005081 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005082
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005083 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00005084 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005085
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005086 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00005087 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
5088 return Arg;
5089
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005090 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
5091 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005092 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005093 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005094 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
5095 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
5096 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005097
Benjamin Kramercce63472015-08-05 09:40:22 +00005098 return TemplateArgument(llvm::makeArrayRef(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size()));
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005099 }
5100 }
5101
5102 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005103 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00005104}
5105
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005106NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005107ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005108 if (!NNS)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005109 return nullptr;
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005110
5111 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
5112 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
5113 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005114 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005115 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
5116 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
5117
5118 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
5119 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
5120 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005121 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00005122 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
5123
5124 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
5125 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
5126 // this namespace and no prefix.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005127 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00005128 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
5129 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005130
5131 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
5132 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
5133 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00005134
5135 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
5136 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
5137 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
5138 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
5139 // types, e.g.,
5140 // typedef typename T::type T1;
5141 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00005142 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
5143 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00005144 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00005145
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00005146 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
5147 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
5148 // first place?
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005149 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
5150 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005151 }
5152
5153 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
Nikola Smiljanic67860242014-09-26 00:28:20 +00005154 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
5155 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005156 return NNS;
5157 }
5158
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00005159 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00005160}
5161
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005162const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005163 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005164 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005165 // Handle the common positive case fast.
5166 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
5167 return AT;
5168 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005169
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005170 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005171 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005172 return nullptr;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005173
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005174 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005175 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
5176 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005177
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005178 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
5179 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00005180 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005181
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005182 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005183 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005184
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005185 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005186 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005187 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005188 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005189
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005190 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
5191 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005192 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005193
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005194 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
5195 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
5196 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005197 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005198 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
5199 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
5200 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005201 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00005202
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005203 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00005204 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
5205 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005206 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00005207 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00005208 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005209 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00005210 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005211
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005212 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00005213 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00005214 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005215 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005216 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00005217 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00005218}
5219
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00005220QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Reid Kleckner8a365022013-06-24 17:51:48 +00005221 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
5222 return getDecayedType(T);
5223 return T;
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00005224}
5225
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00005226QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00005227 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
5228 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
5229 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
5230}
5231
David Majnemerd09a51c2015-03-03 01:50:05 +00005232QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
5233 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
5234 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
5235 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
5236 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
5237 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
5238 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
5239 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
5240 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
5241 T = getDecayedType(T);
5242 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
5243}
5244
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00005245/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
5246/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
5247/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
5248/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
5249///
5250/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005251QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005252 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
5253 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
5254 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
5255 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
5256 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
5257 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005258
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00005259 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00005260
5261 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
Jordan Rose303e2f12016-11-10 23:28:17 +00005262 QualType Result = getQualifiedType(PtrTy,
5263 PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
5264
5265 // int x[_Nullable] -> int * _Nullable
5266 if (auto Nullability = Ty->getNullability(*this)) {
5267 Result = const_cast<ASTContext *>(this)->getAttributedType(
5268 AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Nullability), Result, Result);
5269 }
5270 return Result;
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00005271}
5272
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005273QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
5274 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00005275}
5276
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005277QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
5278 Qualifiers qs;
5279 while (true) {
5280 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005281 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005282 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005283
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005284 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00005285 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005286 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005287
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005288 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00005289}
5290
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005291/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005292uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005293ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
5294 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
5295 do {
5296 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00005297 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
5298 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00005299 } while (CA);
5300 return ElementCount;
5301}
5302
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00005303/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
5304/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005305static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005306 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00005307 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005308
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005309 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
5310 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005311 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00005312 case BuiltinType::Float16: return Float16Rank;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00005313 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00005314 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
5315 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
5316 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005317 case BuiltinType::Float128: return Float128Rank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005318 }
5319}
5320
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005321/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
5322/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00005323/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
5324/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005325QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
5326 QualType Domain) const {
5327 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
5328 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
5329 switch (EltRank) {
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00005330 case Float16Rank:
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00005331 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005332 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
5333 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
5334 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005335 case Float128Rank: return Float128ComplexTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005336 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00005337 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005338
5339 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
5340 switch (EltRank) {
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00005341 case Float16Rank: return HalfTy;
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00005342 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00005343 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
5344 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
5345 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00005346 case Float128Rank: return Float128Ty;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00005347 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00005348 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005349}
5350
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005351/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
5352/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
5353/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005354/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005355int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005356 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
5357 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005358
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005359 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00005360 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00005361 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00005362 return 1;
5363 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005364}
5365
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005366/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
5367/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
5368/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00005369unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00005370 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00005371
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005372 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005373 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005374 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005375 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005376 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5377 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5378 case BuiltinType::SChar:
5379 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005380 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005381 case BuiltinType::Short:
5382 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005383 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005384 case BuiltinType::Int:
5385 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005386 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005387 case BuiltinType::Long:
5388 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005389 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005390 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
5391 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00005392 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00005393 case BuiltinType::Int128:
5394 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
5395 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005396 }
5397}
5398
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005399/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
5400/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
5401///
5402/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
5403/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005404QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00005405 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
5406 return QualType();
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005407
5408 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
5409 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
5410 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
5411
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00005412 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005413 if (!Field)
5414 return QualType();
5415
5416 QualType FT = Field->getType();
5417
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005418 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005419 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005420 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
5421 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
5422 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
5423 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
5424 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
5425 // promotion applies to it.
5426 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
5427 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
5428 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
5429 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
5430 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
5431 //
5432 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
5433 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005434 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
5435 return IntTy;
5436
5437 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
5438 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
5439
5440 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
Richard Smith5b571672014-09-24 23:55:00 +00005441 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
5442 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
5443 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
5444 // into their semantics in some cases).
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005445 return QualType();
5446}
5447
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005448/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
5449/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
5450/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005451QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005452 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
5453 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00005454 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
5455 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00005456
5457 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5458 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
5459 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
5460 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
5461 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
5462 // unsigned long long int [...]
5463 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
5464 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
5465 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
5466 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
5467 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
5468 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
5469 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
5470 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
5471 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
5472 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
5473 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
5474 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
5475 (FromSize == ToSize &&
5476 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
5477 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
5478 }
5479 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
5480 }
5481 }
5482
5483 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005484 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
5485 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00005486 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
5487 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00005488 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
5489 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
5490}
5491
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00005492/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
5493/// type and returns its ownership.
5494Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
5495 while (!T.isNull()) {
5496 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
5497 return T.getObjCLifetime();
5498 if (T->isArrayType())
5499 T = getBaseElementType(T);
5500 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
5501 T = PT->getPointeeType();
5502 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00005503 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00005504 else
5505 break;
5506 }
5507
5508 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
5509}
5510
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005511static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
5512 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
5513 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
5514 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
5515 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005516 return nullptr;
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005517}
5518
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005519/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005520/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005521/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005522int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00005523 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
5524 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Ted Kremeneke65ab9e2013-10-10 00:54:01 +00005525
5526 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
5527 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
5528 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
5529 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
5530 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
5531
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005532 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005533
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005534 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
5535 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005536
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005537 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
5538 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005539
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005540 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
5541 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
5542 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
5543 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005544
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005545 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
5546 if (LHSUnsigned) {
5547 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
5548 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
5549 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005550
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005551 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
5552 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005553 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005554 return -1;
5555 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00005556
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005557 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
5558 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
5559 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005560
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005561 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
5562 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005563 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00005564 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005565}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005566
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005567TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringDecl() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005568 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005569 assert(!CFConstantStringTagDecl &&
5570 "tag and typedef should be initialized together");
5571 CFConstantStringTagDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__NSConstantString_tag");
5572 CFConstantStringTagDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00005573
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00005574 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005575 const char *FieldNames[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005576
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005577 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005578 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005579 FieldNames[0] = "isa";
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00005580 // int flags;
5581 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005582 FieldNames[1] = "flags";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005583 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005584 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005585 FieldNames[2] = "str";
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005586 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005587 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005588 FieldNames[3] = "length";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005589
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005590 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00005591 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005592 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTagDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00005593 SourceLocation(),
Ben Langmuir4791a802016-02-25 16:36:26 +00005594 SourceLocation(),
5595 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005596 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5597 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00005598 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00005599 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005600 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005601 CFConstantStringTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00005602 }
5603
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005604 CFConstantStringTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5605 // This type is designed to be compatible with NSConstantString, but cannot
5606 // use the same name, since NSConstantString is an interface.
5607 auto tagType = getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTagDecl);
5608 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
5609 buildImplicitTypedef(tagType, "__NSConstantString");
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00005610 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005611
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00005612 return CFConstantStringTypeDecl;
5613}
5614
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005615RecordDecl *ASTContext::getCFConstantStringTagDecl() const {
5616 if (!CFConstantStringTagDecl)
5617 getCFConstantStringDecl(); // Build the tag and the typedef.
5618 return CFConstantStringTagDecl;
5619}
5620
Quentin Colombet043406b2016-02-03 22:41:00 +00005621// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
5622QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005623 return getTypedefType(getCFConstantStringDecl());
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00005624}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00005625
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00005626QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
5627 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005628 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00005629 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
5630 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
5631 }
5632 return ObjCSuperType;
5633}
5634
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00005635void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ben Langmuirf5416742016-02-04 00:55:24 +00005636 const TypedefType *TD = T->getAs<TypedefType>();
5637 assert(TD && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
5638 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = cast<TypedefDecl>(TD->getDecl());
5639 auto TagType =
5640 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<RecordType>();
5641 assert(TagType && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
5642 CFConstantStringTagDecl = TagType->getDecl();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00005643}
5644
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005645QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005646 if (BlockDescriptorType)
5647 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
5648
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005649 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005650 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005651 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
5652 RD->startDefinition();
5653
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005654 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5655 UnsignedLongTy,
5656 UnsignedLongTy,
5657 };
5658
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005659 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005660 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005661 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005662 };
5663
5664 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005665 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5666 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005667 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5668 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005669 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005670 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005671 }
5672
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005673 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005674
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005675 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00005676
5677 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
5678}
5679
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005680QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005681 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
5682 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5683
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005684 RecordDecl *RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005685 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005686 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
5687 RD->startDefinition();
5688
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005689 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
5690 UnsignedLongTy,
5691 UnsignedLongTy,
5692 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
5693 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
5694 };
5695
Craig Topperd6d31ac2013-07-15 08:24:27 +00005696 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005697 "reserved",
5698 "Size",
5699 "CopyFuncPtr",
5700 "DestroyFuncPtr"
5701 };
5702
5703 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005704 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
5705 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005706 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5707 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005708 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00005709 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005710 RD->addDecl(Field);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005711 }
5712
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005713 RD->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005714
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00005715 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00005716 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
5717}
5718
Sven van Haastregt3bb7eaf2017-12-06 10:11:28 +00005719TargetInfo::OpenCLTypeKind ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeKind(const Type *T) const {
5720 auto BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(T);
5721
5722 if (!BT) {
5723 if (isa<PipeType>(T))
5724 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Pipe;
5725
5726 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Default;
5727 }
5728
5729 switch (BT->getKind()) {
5730#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
5731 case BuiltinType::Id: \
5732 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Image;
5733#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
5734
5735 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
5736 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_ClkEvent;
5737
5738 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
5739 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Event;
5740
5741 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
5742 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Queue;
5743
5744 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
5745 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_ReserveID;
5746
5747 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
5748 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Sampler;
5749
5750 default:
5751 return TargetInfo::OCLTK_Default;
5752 }
5753}
5754
5755LangAS ASTContext::getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(const Type *T) const {
5756 return Target->getOpenCLTypeAddrSpace(getOpenCLTypeKind(T));
5757}
5758
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005759/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
5760/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
5761/// in buildByrefHelpers.
5762bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
5763 const VarDecl *D) {
5764 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
5765 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
5766 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
5767
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005768 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00005769 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005770
5771 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
5772
5773 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
5774
5775 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
5776 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00005777 switch (lifetime) {
5778 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
5779
5780 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
5781 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
5782 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
5783 return false;
5784
5785 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
5786 // byref routines.
5787 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
5788 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
5789 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
5790 return true;
5791 }
5792 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
5793 }
5794 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
5795 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00005796}
5797
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005798bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
5799 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
5800 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005801 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
5802 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
5803 return false;
5804
5805 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00005806 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005807 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
5808 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005809 } else if ((LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime())) {
5810 // Honor the ARC qualifiers.
5811 } else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType()) {
5812 // The MRR rule.
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005813 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005814 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005815 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
John McCall460ce582015-10-22 18:38:17 +00005816 }
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00005817 return true;
5818}
5819
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005820TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
5821 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00005822 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
5823 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00005824 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
5825}
5826
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005827// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
5828// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00005829static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005830 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00005831 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
5832 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005833
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005834 return false;
5835}
5836
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00005837/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005838/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005839CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005840 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
5841 return CharUnits::Zero();
5842
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005843 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005844
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005845 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00005846 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005847 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005848 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
5849 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005850 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005851 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005852}
5853
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005854bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00005855 return getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
5856 VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
David Majnemerfac52432015-10-19 23:22:49 +00005857 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5858 !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00005859}
5860
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005861ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind
5862ASTContext::getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(const VarDecl *VD) const {
5863 if (!VD->isInline())
5864 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None;
5865
5866 // In almost all cases, it's a weak definition.
5867 auto *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
Richard Smith8910fe62017-10-23 03:58:34 +00005868 if (First->isInlineSpecified() || !First->isStaticDataMember())
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005869 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak;
5870
5871 // If there's a file-context declaration in this translation unit, it's a
5872 // non-discardable definition.
5873 for (auto *D : VD->redecls())
Richard Smith8910fe62017-10-23 03:58:34 +00005874 if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFileContext() &&
5875 !D->isInlineSpecified() && (D->isConstexpr() || First->isConstexpr()))
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00005876 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong;
5877
5878 // If we've not seen one yet, we don't know.
5879 return InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown;
5880}
5881
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005882static inline
5883std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
5884 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00005885}
5886
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005887/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005888/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005889std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
5890 std::string S;
5891
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005892 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
5893 QualType BlockTy =
5894 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5895 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005896 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005897 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
5898 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
5899 true /*Extended*/);
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005900 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005901 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005902 // Compute size of all parameters.
5903 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5904 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005905 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5906 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005907 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanb2b8b1d2014-03-07 16:09:59 +00005908 QualType PType = PI->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005909 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00005910 if (sz.isZero())
5911 continue;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00005912 assert(sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005913 ParmOffset += sz;
5914 }
5915 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005916 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005917 // Block pointer and offset.
5918 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005919
5920 // Argument types.
5921 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005922 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005923 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5924 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5925 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5926 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5927 // elements.
5928 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5929 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5930 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5931 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00005932 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00005933 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5934 S, true /*Extended*/);
5935 else
5936 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00005937 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00005938 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005939 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00005940
5941 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00005942}
5943
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005944std::string
5945ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl) const {
5946 std::string S;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005947 // Encode result type.
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00005948 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005949 CharUnits ParmOffset;
5950 // Compute size of all parameters.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005951 for (auto PI : Decl->parameters()) {
Aaron Ballmanf6bf62e2014-03-07 15:12:56 +00005952 QualType PType = PI->getType();
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005953 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005954 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00005955 continue;
5956
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005957 assert(sz.isPositive() &&
5958 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005959 ParmOffset += sz;
5960 }
5961 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5962 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5963
5964 // Argument types.
David Majnemer59f77922016-06-24 04:05:48 +00005965 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->parameters()) {
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005966 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5967 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5968 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5969 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5970 // elements.
5971 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5972 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5973 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5974 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5975 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5976 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5977 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5978 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00005979
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00005980 return S;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00005981}
5982
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005983/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5984/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5985/// block object types.
5986void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5987 QualType T, std::string& S,
5988 bool Extended) const {
5989 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5990 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5991 // Encode parameter type.
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00005992 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005993 true /*OutermostType*/,
5994 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
5995 false /*StructField*/,
5996 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5997 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5998}
5999
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006000/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006001/// declaration.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006002std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
6003 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006004 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006005 // Encode return type.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006006 std::string S;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006007 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
6008 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006009 // Compute size of all parameters.
6010 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
6011 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006012 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006013 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
6014 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006015 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00006016 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00006017 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00006018 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00006019 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00006020 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00006021 continue;
6022
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006023 assert(sz.isPositive() &&
6024 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006025 ParmOffset += sz;
6026 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006027 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006028 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006029 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006030
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006031 // Argument types.
6032 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00006033 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00006034 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00006035 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006036 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00006037 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00006038 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
6039 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
6040 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00006041 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00006042 PType = PVDecl->getType();
6043 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
6044 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006045 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
6046 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00006047 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00006048 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006049 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00006050
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006051 return S;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00006052}
6053
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006054ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
6055ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
6056 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
6057 const Decl *Container) const {
6058 if (!Container)
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006059 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006060 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
6061 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
Aaron Ballmand85eff42014-03-14 15:02:45 +00006062 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
6063 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
6064 return PID;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006065 } else {
6066 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
6067 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
6068 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
6069 return PID;
6070 }
6071 return nullptr;
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006072}
6073
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006074/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00006075/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006076/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
6077/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006078/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
6079/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
6080/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
6081/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
6082/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00006083/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
6084/// @code
6085/// enum PropertyAttributes {
6086/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
6087/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
6088/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
6089/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
6090/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
6091/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
6092/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00006093/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00006094/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
6095/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
6096/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
6097/// };
6098/// @endcode
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006099std::string
6100ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
6101 const Decl *Container) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006102 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
6103 bool Dynamic = false;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006104 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006105
Fariborz Jahaniandad96302014-01-22 19:02:20 +00006106 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
6107 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
6108 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
6109 Dynamic = true;
6110 else
6111 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006112 }
6113
6114 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006115 std::string S = "T";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006116
6117 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00006118 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
6119 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00006120 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006121
6122 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
6123 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00006124 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
6125 S += ",C";
6126 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
6127 S += ",&";
Fariborz Jahanian33079ee2014-04-02 22:49:42 +00006128 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
6129 S += ",W";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006130 } else {
6131 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
6132 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
6133 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006134 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00006135 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006136 }
6137 }
6138
6139 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
6140 // are "dynamic by default".
6141 if (Dynamic)
6142 S += ",D";
6143
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00006144 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
6145 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006146
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006147 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
6148 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00006149 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006150 }
6151
6152 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
6153 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00006154 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006155 }
6156
6157 if (SynthesizePID) {
6158 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
6159 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00006160 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006161 }
6162
6163 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
John McCall843dfcc2016-11-29 21:57:00 +00006164 return S;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00006165}
6166
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006167/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006168/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
6169/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006170/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006171void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00006172 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006173 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006174 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006175 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006176 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006177 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006178 PointeeTy = IntTy;
6179 }
6180 }
6181}
6182
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006183void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006184 const FieldDecl *Field,
6185 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00006186 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
6187 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
6188 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
6189 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006190 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006191 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
6192 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00006193}
6194
Joe Groff98ac7d22014-07-07 22:25:15 +00006195void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
6196 std::string& S) const {
6197 // Encode result type.
6198 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
6199 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
6200 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
6201 true /* outermost type */,
6202 true /* encoding property */);
6203}
6204
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006205static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
6206 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
6207 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006208 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
6209 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
6210 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
6211 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006212 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006213 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006214 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006215 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
6216 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006217 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006218 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
6219 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
6220 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
6221 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
6222 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00006223 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
6224 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006225 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
6226 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006227 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006228 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
6229 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
6230 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
6231 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00006232 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006233 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
6234
Sjoerd Meijercc623ad2017-09-08 15:15:00 +00006235 case BuiltinType::Float16:
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00006236 case BuiltinType::Float128:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006237 case BuiltinType::Half:
6238 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
6239 return ' ';
6240
6241 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
6242 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
6243 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
6244 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
6245
6246 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
Alexey Bader954ba212016-04-08 13:40:33 +00006247#define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \
6248 case BuiltinType::Id:
Alexey Baderb62f1442016-04-13 08:33:41 +00006249#include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def"
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00006250 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00006251 case BuiltinType::OCLClkEvent:
6252 case BuiltinType::OCLQueue:
Alexey Bader9c8453f2015-09-15 11:18:52 +00006253 case BuiltinType::OCLReserveID:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00006254 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006255 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
6256#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
6257#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
6258 case BuiltinType::KIND:
6259#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
6260 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006261 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00006262 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006263}
6264
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00006265static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
6266 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
6267
6268 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
6269 if (!Enum->isFixed())
6270 return 'i';
6271
6272 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006273 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
6274 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00006275}
6276
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006277static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006278 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006279 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00006280 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006281 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
6282 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
6283 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
6284 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
6285 //
6286 // struct
6287 // {
6288 // int integer;
6289 // int flags:2;
6290 // };
6291 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
6292 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
6293 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
6294 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
6295 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00006296 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
Akira Hatanaka4b1c4842017-06-27 04:34:04 +00006297 uint64_t Offset;
6298
6299 if (const auto *IVD = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(FD)) {
6300 Offset = Ctx->lookupFieldBitOffset(IVD->getContainingInterface(), nullptr,
6301 IVD);
6302 } else {
6303 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
6304 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
6305 Offset = RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex());
6306 }
6307
6308 S += llvm::utostr(Offset);
6309
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00006310 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
6311 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006312 else {
6313 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
6314 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
6315 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006316 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006317 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00006318}
6319
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00006320// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00006321void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
6322 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
6323 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00006324 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00006325 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006326 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006327 bool StructField,
6328 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006329 bool EncodeClassNames,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006330 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
6331 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006332 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
6333 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
6334 case Type::Builtin:
6335 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006336 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00006337 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006338 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
6339 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
6340 else
6341 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006342 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006343
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006344 case Type::Complex: {
6345 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00006346 S += 'j';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006347 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006348 return;
6349 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006350
6351 case Type::Atomic: {
6352 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
6353 S += 'A';
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006354 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006355 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00006356 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006357
6358 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
6359 case Type::Pointer:
6360 case Type::LValueReference:
6361 case Type::RValueReference: {
6362 QualType PointeeTy;
6363 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
6364 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
6365 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
6366 S += ':';
6367 return;
6368 }
6369 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
6370 } else {
6371 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
6372 }
6373
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006374 bool isReadOnly = false;
6375 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
6376 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
6377 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006378 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00006379 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006380 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
6381 isReadOnly = true;
6382 S += 'r';
6383 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00006384 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006385 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006386 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
6387 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006388 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
6389 isReadOnly = true;
6390 S += 'r';
6391 }
6392 }
6393 if (isReadOnly) {
6394 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
6395 // combinations need to be rearranged.
6396 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006397 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00006398 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006399 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006400
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006401 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
6402 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
6403 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00006404 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006405 S += '*';
6406 return;
6407 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006408 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00006409 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
6410 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
6411 S += '#';
6412 return;
6413 }
6414 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
6415 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
6416 S += '@';
6417 return;
6418 }
6419 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006420 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006421 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00006422 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
6423
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006424 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006425 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
6426 NotEncodedT);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006427 return;
6428 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006429
6430 case Type::ConstantArray:
6431 case Type::IncompleteArray:
6432 case Type::VariableArray: {
6433 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
6434
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006435 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006436 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
6437 S += '^';
6438
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006439 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006440 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
6441 } else {
6442 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006443
Fariborz Jahanianf0dc11a2013-06-04 16:04:37 +00006444 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
6445 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
6446 else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006447 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006448 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
6449 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006450 S += '0';
6451 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006452
6453 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006454 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
6455 false, false, false, false, false, false,
6456 NotEncodedT);
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00006457 S += ']';
6458 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006459 return;
6460 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006461
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006462 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
6463 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00006464 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006465 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006466
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006467 case Type::Record: {
6468 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006469 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00006470 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
6471 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
6472 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00006473 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
6474 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
6475 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00006476 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
Serge Pavlov03e672c2017-11-28 16:14:14 +00006477 printTemplateArgumentList(OS, TemplateArgs.asArray(),
6478 getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00006479 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00006480 } else {
6481 S += '?';
6482 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00006483 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006484 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006485 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006486 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006487 } else {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006488 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006489 if (FD) {
6490 S += '"';
6491 S += Field->getNameAsString();
6492 S += '"';
6493 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006494
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006495 // Special case bit-fields.
6496 if (Field->isBitField()) {
6497 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00006498 Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006499 } else {
6500 QualType qt = Field->getType();
6501 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6502 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
6503 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
6504 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006505 /*StructField*/true,
6506 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006507 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006508 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00006509 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00006510 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00006511 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006512 return;
6513 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006514
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006515 case Type::BlockPointer: {
6516 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00006517 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006518 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006519 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006520
6521 S += '<';
6522 // Block return type
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00006523 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
6524 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
6525 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006526 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
6527 NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006528 // Block self
6529 S += "@?";
6530 // Block parameters
6531 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
Aaron Ballman40bd0aa2014-03-17 15:23:01 +00006532 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
6533 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
6534 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
6535 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006536 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
6537 false, NotEncodedT);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006538 }
6539 S += '>';
6540 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006541 return;
6542 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006543
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00006544 case Type::ObjCObject: {
6545 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
6546 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
6547 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
6548 S += "{objc_object=}";
6549 return;
6550 }
6551 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
6552 S += "{objc_class=}";
6553 return;
6554 }
Galina Kistanovaf87496d2017-06-03 06:31:42 +00006555 // TODO: Double check to make sure this intentially falls through.
6556 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
Fariborz Jahanian33fa9622014-01-28 20:41:15 +00006557 }
6558
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006559 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
6560 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006561 // @encode(class_name)
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00006562 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006563 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006564 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Akira Hatanakafd0fb202016-08-17 19:42:22 +00006565 if (ExpandStructures) {
6566 S += '=';
6567 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
6568 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
6569 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
6570 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
6571 if (Field->isBitField())
6572 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
6573 else
6574 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
6575 false, false, false, false, false,
6576 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
6577 NotEncodedT);
6578 }
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006579 }
6580 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006581 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00006582 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006583
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006584 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
6585 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006586 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
6587 S += '@';
6588 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006589 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006590
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00006591 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
6592 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
6593 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
6594 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006595 S += '#';
6596 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006597 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006598
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006599 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006600 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006601 ExpandPointedToStructures,
6602 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006603 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006604 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
6605 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006606 S += '"';
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006607 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006608 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006609 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006610 S += '>';
6611 }
6612 S += '"';
6613 }
6614 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006615 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006616
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006617 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
6618 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006619 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
6620 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006621 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006622 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006623 // {...};
6624 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006625 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc682ef52013-07-12 16:41:56 +00006626 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006627 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
6628 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
6629 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
6630 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
6631 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
6632 S += '{';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006633 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Fariborz Jahanian88890e72013-07-12 16:19:11 +00006634 S += '}';
6635 return;
6636 }
6637 }
6638 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006639 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
6640 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006641 nullptr,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00006642 false, false, false, false, false,
6643 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006644 return;
6645 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006646
6647 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00006648 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
6649 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006650 S += '"';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006651 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00006652 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006653 S += '<';
Douglas Gregorb32684e2015-06-16 21:04:55 +00006654 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006655 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006656 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00006657 S += '"';
6658 }
6659 return;
6660 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006661
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00006662 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006663 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
6664 case Type::MemberPointer:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006665 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
6666 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006667 case Type::Vector:
6668 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006669 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006670 if (NotEncodedT)
6671 *NotEncodedT = T;
6672 return;
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006673
6674 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
6675 // Just ignore it.
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00006676 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00006677 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00006678 return;
6679
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00006680 case Type::Pipe:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006681#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
6682#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
6683#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6684 case Type::KIND:
6685#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6686 case Type::KIND:
6687#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
6688 case Type::KIND:
6689#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
6690 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00006691 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00006692 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00006693}
6694
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006695void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
6696 std::string &S,
6697 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006698 bool includeVBases,
6699 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006700 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
6701 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
Argyrios Kyrtzidis785705b2016-01-16 00:20:02 +00006702 if (!RDecl->getDefinition() || RDecl->getDefinition()->isInvalidDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006703 return;
6704
6705 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
6706 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
6707 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
6708
6709 if (CXXRec) {
Aaron Ballman574705e2014-03-13 15:41:46 +00006710 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
6711 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
6712 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006713 if (base->isEmpty())
6714 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006715 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006716 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
6717 std::make_pair(offs, base));
6718 }
6719 }
6720 }
6721
6722 unsigned i = 0;
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00006723 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006724 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
6725 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Hans Wennborga302cd92014-08-21 16:06:57 +00006726 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
6727 ++i;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006728 }
6729
6730 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
Aaron Ballman445a9392014-03-13 16:15:17 +00006731 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
6732 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006733 if (base->isEmpty())
6734 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00006735 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Eli Friedman1d24af82013-09-18 01:59:16 +00006736 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
6737 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00006738 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
6739 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006740 }
6741 }
6742
6743 CharUnits size;
6744 if (CXXRec) {
6745 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
6746 } else {
6747 size = layout.getSize();
6748 }
6749
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006750#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006751 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006752#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006753 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
6754 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
6755
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00006756 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
6757 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006758 if (FD) {
6759 S += "\"_vptr$";
6760 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
6761 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
6762 S += recname;
6763 S += '"';
6764 }
6765 S += "^^?";
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006766#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006767 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006768#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006769 }
6770
6771 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
6772 // Mark the end of the structure.
6773 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
6774 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006775 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006776 }
6777
6778 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006779#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006780 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006781 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
6782 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
6783 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
6784 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
6785 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
6786 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
6787 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
6788 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
6789 // longer then though.
6790 CurOffs += padding;
6791 }
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006792#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006793
6794 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006795 if (!dcl)
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006796 break; // reached end of structure.
6797
6798 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
6799 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
6800 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
6801 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
6802 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006803 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
6804 NotEncodedT);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006805 assert(!base->isEmpty());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006806#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00006807 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006808#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006809 } else {
6810 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
6811 if (FD) {
6812 S += '"';
6813 S += field->getNameAsString();
6814 S += '"';
6815 }
6816
6817 if (field->isBitField()) {
6818 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006819#ifndef NDEBUG
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00006820 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006821#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006822 } else {
6823 QualType qt = field->getType();
6824 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
6825 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
6826 /*OutermostType*/false,
6827 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
Fariborz Jahanian4bf437e2014-08-22 23:17:52 +00006828 /*StructField*/true,
6829 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006830#ifndef NDEBUG
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006831 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
Fariborz Jahanianf1a66de2014-01-07 01:02:50 +00006832#endif
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00006833 }
6834 }
6835 }
6836}
6837
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006838void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00006839 std::string& S) const {
6840 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
6841 S += 'n';
6842 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
6843 S += 'N';
6844 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
6845 S += 'o';
6846 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
6847 S += 'O';
6848 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
6849 S += 'R';
6850 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
6851 S += 'V';
6852}
6853
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006854TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
6855 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006856 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, {}, {});
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006857 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006858 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006859 }
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00006860 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00006861}
6862
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006863TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
6864 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006865 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
6866 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00006867 }
6868 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00006869}
6870
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006871TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
6872 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00006873 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, {}, {});
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006874 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006875 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006876 }
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00006877 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00006878}
6879
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006880ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
6881 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
6882 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
6883 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6884 SourceLocation(),
6885 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
Douglas Gregor85f3f952015-07-07 03:57:15 +00006886 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006887 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00006888 SourceLocation(), true);
6889 }
6890
6891 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
6892}
6893
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006894//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6895// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
6896//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6897
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006898static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6899 StringRef Name) {
6900 // typedef char* __builtin[_ms]_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006901 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00006902 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, Name);
6903}
6904
6905static TypedefDecl *CreateMSVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6906 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_ms_va_list");
6907}
6908
6909static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6910 return CreateCharPtrNamedVaListDecl(Context, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006911}
6912
6913static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6914 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006915 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6916 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006917}
6918
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006919static TypedefDecl *
6920CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006921 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006922 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006923 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6924 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6925 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6926 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6927 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006928 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006929 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006930 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006931 NS->setImplicit();
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006932 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006933 }
6934
6935 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6936
6937 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6938 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6939 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6940
6941 // void *__stack;
6942 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6943 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6944
6945 // void *__gr_top;
6946 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6947 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6948
6949 // void *__vr_top;
6950 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6951 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6952
6953 // int __gr_offs;
6954 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6955 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6956
6957 // int __vr_offs;
6958 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6959 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6960
6961 // Create fields
6962 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6963 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6964 VaListTagDecl,
6965 SourceLocation(),
6966 SourceLocation(),
6967 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00006968 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6969 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006970 /*Mutable=*/false,
6971 ICIS_NoInit);
6972 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6973 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6974 }
6975 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00006976 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006977 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006978
6979 // } __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00006980 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006981}
6982
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006983static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6984 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6985 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6986
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00006987 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006988 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6989
6990 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6991 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6992 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6993
6994 // unsigned char gpr;
6995 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6996 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6997
6998 // unsigned char fpr;
6999 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
7000 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
7001
7002 // unsigned short reserved;
7003 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
7004 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
7005
7006 // void* overflow_arg_area;
7007 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7008 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
7009
7010 // void* reg_save_area;
7011 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7012 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
7013
7014 // Create fields
7015 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
7016 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
7017 SourceLocation(),
7018 SourceLocation(),
7019 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007020 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7021 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007022 /*Mutable=*/false,
7023 ICIS_NoInit);
7024 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7025 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
7026 }
7027 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007028 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007029 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
7030
7031 // } __va_list_tag;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007032 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
7033 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
7034
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007035 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
7036 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
7037
7038 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
7039 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
7040 QualType VaListTagArrayType
7041 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
7042 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007043 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007044}
7045
7046static TypedefDecl *
7047CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007048 // struct __va_list_tag {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007049 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00007050 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007051 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
7052
7053 const size_t NumFields = 4;
7054 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
7055 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
7056
7057 // unsigned gp_offset;
7058 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
7059 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
7060
7061 // unsigned fp_offset;
7062 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
7063 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
7064
7065 // void* overflow_arg_area;
7066 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7067 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
7068
7069 // void* reg_save_area;
7070 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7071 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
7072
7073 // Create fields
7074 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
7075 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7076 VaListTagDecl,
7077 SourceLocation(),
7078 SourceLocation(),
7079 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007080 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7081 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007082 /*Mutable=*/false,
7083 ICIS_NoInit);
7084 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7085 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
7086 }
7087 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007088 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007089 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
7090
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007091 // };
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007092
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007093 // typedef struct __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007094 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007095 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
7096 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007097 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007098}
7099
7100static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
7101 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
7102 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
Yaron Kerene0bcdd42016-10-08 06:45:10 +00007103 QualType IntArrayType =
7104 Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007105 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007106}
7107
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007108static TypedefDecl *
7109CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007110 // struct __va_list
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00007111 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007112 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7113 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
7114 NamespaceDecl *NS;
7115 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7116 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
7117 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
7118 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007119 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007120 NS->setImplicit();
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007121 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007122 }
7123
7124 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
7125
7126 // void * __ap;
7127 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7128 VaListDecl,
7129 SourceLocation(),
7130 SourceLocation(),
7131 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
7132 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007133 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7134 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007135 /*Mutable=*/false,
7136 ICIS_NoInit);
7137 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7138 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
7139
7140 // };
7141 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
Oleg Ranevskyyb88d2472016-03-30 21:30:30 +00007142 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListDecl;
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007143
7144 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007145 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
7146 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007147}
7148
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007149static TypedefDecl *
7150CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007151 // struct __va_list_tag {
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007152 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
Alp Toker2dea15b2013-12-17 01:22:38 +00007153 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007154 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
7155
7156 const size_t NumFields = 4;
7157 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
7158 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
7159
7160 // long __gpr;
7161 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
7162 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
7163
7164 // long __fpr;
7165 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
7166 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
7167
7168 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
7169 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7170 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
7171
7172 // void *__reg_save_area;
7173 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
7174 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
7175
7176 // Create fields
7177 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
7178 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
7179 VaListTagDecl,
7180 SourceLocation(),
7181 SourceLocation(),
7182 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007183 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
7184 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007185 /*Mutable=*/false,
7186 ICIS_NoInit);
7187 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
7188 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
7189 }
7190 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007191 Context->VaListTagDecl = VaListTagDecl;
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007192 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007193
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007194 // };
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007195
7196 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
7197 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007198 QualType VaListTagArrayType =
7199 Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagType, Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007200
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007201 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007202}
7203
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007204static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
7205 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
7206 switch (Kind) {
7207 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
7208 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
7209 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
7210 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00007211 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
7212 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007213 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
7214 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
7215 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
7216 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
7217 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
7218 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00007219 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
7220 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00007221 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
7222 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007223 }
7224
7225 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
7226}
7227
7228TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007229 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007230 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
Alp Toker56b5cc92013-12-15 10:36:26 +00007231 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
7232 }
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00007233
7234 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
7235}
7236
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007237Decl *ASTContext::getVaListTagDecl() const {
7238 // Force the creation of VaListTagDecl by building the __builtin_va_list
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00007239 // declaration.
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007240 if (!VaListTagDecl)
7241 (void)getBuiltinVaListDecl();
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00007242
Richard Smith9b88a4c2015-07-27 05:40:23 +00007243 return VaListTagDecl;
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00007244}
7245
Charles Davisc7d5c942015-09-17 20:55:33 +00007246TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinMSVaListDecl() const {
7247 if (!BuiltinMSVaListDecl)
7248 BuiltinMSVaListDecl = CreateMSVaListDecl(this);
7249
7250 return BuiltinMSVaListDecl;
7251}
7252
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00007253void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007254 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00007255 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007256
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00007257 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00007258}
7259
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00007260/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
7261/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007262TemplateName
7263ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
7264 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00007265 unsigned size = End - Begin;
7266 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
7267
7268 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
7269 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
7270 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
7271
7272 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00007273 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00007274 NamedDecl *D = *I;
7275 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
7276 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
7277 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
7278 *Storage++ = D;
7279 }
7280
7281 return TemplateName(OT);
7282}
7283
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007284/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
7285/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007286TemplateName
7287ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
7288 bool TemplateKeyword,
7289 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00007290 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
7291
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007292 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007293 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7294 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
7295
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007296 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007297 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
7298 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7299 if (!QTN) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007300 QTN = new (*this, alignof(QualifiedTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007301 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007302 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7303 }
7304
7305 return TemplateName(QTN);
7306}
7307
7308/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
7309/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007310TemplateName
7311ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
7312 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007313 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00007314 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007315
7316 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7317 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
7318
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007319 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007320 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
7321 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7322
7323 if (QTN)
7324 return TemplateName(QTN);
7325
7326 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
7327 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007328 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007329 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007330 } else {
7331 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007332 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007333 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007334 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
7335 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7336 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
7337 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00007338 }
7339
7340 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7341 return TemplateName(QTN);
7342}
7343
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007344/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
7345/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
7346TemplateName
7347ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007348 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007349 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
7350 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
7351
7352 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7353 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007354
7355 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007356 DependentTemplateName *QTN
7357 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007358
7359 if (QTN)
7360 return TemplateName(QTN);
7361
7362 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
7363 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007364 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007365 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007366 } else {
7367 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007368 QTN = new (*this, alignof(DependentTemplateName))
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00007369 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Benjamin Kramerc3f89252016-10-20 14:27:22 +00007370
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00007371 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
7372 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7373 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
7374 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00007375 }
7376
7377 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
7378 return TemplateName(QTN);
7379}
7380
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007381TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007382ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
7383 TemplateName replacement) const {
7384 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7385 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007386
7387 void *insertPos = nullptr;
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007388 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
7389 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
7390
7391 if (!subst) {
7392 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
7393 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
7394 }
7395
7396 return TemplateName(subst);
7397}
7398
7399TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007400ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
7401 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
7402 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
7403 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
7404 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00007405
7406 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007407 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
7408 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
7409
7410 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00007411 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00007412 ArgPack.pack_size(),
7413 ArgPack.pack_begin());
7414 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
7415 }
7416
7417 return TemplateName(Subst);
7418}
7419
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007420/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00007421/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
7422/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00007423CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007424 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00007425 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00007426 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
7427 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007428 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
7429 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
7430 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
7431 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
7432 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
7433 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
7434 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
7435 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
7436 }
7437
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007438 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00007439}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00007440
7441//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7442// Type Predicates.
7443//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7444
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007445/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
7446/// garbage collection attribute.
7447///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007448Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007449 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007450 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
7451
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007452 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00007453 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
7454
7455 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
7456 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
7457 // as __strong.
7458 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
7459 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
7460 return Qualifiers::Strong;
7461 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
7462 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
7463 } else {
7464 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
7465 // pointer.
7466#ifndef NDEBUG
7467 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
7468 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
7469 CT = AT->getElementType();
7470 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
7471#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007472 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00007473 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00007474}
7475
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007476//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7477// Type Compatibility Testing
7478//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00007479
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007480/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007481/// compatible.
7482static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
7483 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00007484 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007485 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007486 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007487}
7488
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007489bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
7490 QualType SecondVec) {
7491 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
7492 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
7493
7494 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
7495 return true;
7496
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007497 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
7498 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007499 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
7500 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007501 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007502 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00007503 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
7504 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
7505 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
7506 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00007507 return true;
7508
7509 return false;
7510}
7511
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007512//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7513// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
7514//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7515
7516/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
7517/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007518bool
7519ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
7520 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00007521 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007522 return true;
Aaron Ballman0f6e64d2014-03-13 22:58:06 +00007523 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
7524 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007525 return true;
7526 return false;
7527}
7528
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00007529/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
7530/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007531bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
7532 QualType rhs) {
7533 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7534 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00007535 assert((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007536
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007537 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007538 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007539 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007540 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
7541 match = true;
7542 break;
7543 }
7544 }
7545 if (!match)
7546 return false;
7547 }
7548 return true;
7549}
7550
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007551/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
7552/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
7553bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7554 bool compare) {
7555 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007556 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007557 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
7558 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007559 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007560 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
7561 return true;
7562
7563 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007564 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007565
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007566 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007567
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007568 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007569 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007570 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
7571 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007572 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007573 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7574 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7575 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007576 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007577 return false;
7578 }
7579 }
7580 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
7581 return true;
7582 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007583 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007584 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007585 bool match = false;
7586
7587 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7588 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7589 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007590 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007591 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7592 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7593 match = true;
7594 break;
7595 }
7596 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007597 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007598 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
7599 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007600 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007601 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
7602 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7603 // through its super class and categories.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007604 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007605 match = true;
7606 break;
7607 }
7608 }
7609 }
7610 if (!match)
7611 return false;
7612 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007613
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007614 return true;
7615 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007616
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007617 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
7618 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
7619
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007620 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007621 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007622 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007623 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007624 bool match = false;
7625
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007626 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007627 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
7628 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007629 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
7630 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007631 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007632 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7633 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7634 match = true;
7635 break;
7636 }
7637 }
7638 if (!match)
7639 return false;
7640 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007641
7642 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
7643 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
7644 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
7645 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
7646 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
7647 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
7648 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
7649 // assume that it is mismatch.
7650 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
7651 return false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007652 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007653 bool match = false;
Aaron Ballman83731462014-03-17 16:14:00 +00007654 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00007655 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
7656 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
7657 match = true;
7658 break;
7659 }
7660 }
7661 if (!match)
7662 return false;
7663 }
7664 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007665 return true;
7666 }
7667 return false;
7668}
7669
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007670/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00007671/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
7672/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007673bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7674 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007675 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7676 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7677
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00007678 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007679 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
7680 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007681 return true;
7682
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007683 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
7684 // __kindof types.
7685 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7686 if (succeeded)
7687 return true;
7688
7689 if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
7690 return false;
7691
7692 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7693 // we can assign the other way.
7694 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7695 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
7696 };
7697
7698 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
7699 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7700 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7701 false));
7702 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007703
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007704 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
7705 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7706 QualType(RHSOPT,0)));
7707 }
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00007708
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007709 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007710 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
7711 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
7712 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007713
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00007714 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007715}
7716
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007717/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00007718/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007719/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
7720/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
7721/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
7722bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7723 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007724 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
7725 bool BlockReturnType) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007726
7727 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
7728 // __kindof types.
7729 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
7730 if (succeeded)
7731 return true;
7732
7733 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
7734 if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
7735 return false;
7736
7737 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
7738 // we can assign the other way.
7739 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7740 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7741 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
7742 BlockReturnType);
7743 };
7744
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007745 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007746 return true;
7747
7748 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007749 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
7750 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007751 }
7752
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00007753 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007754 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
7755 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
7756 false));
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007757
7758 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7759 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
7760 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
7761 if (LHS != RHS) {
7762 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007763 return finish(BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007764 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007765 return finish(!BlockReturnType);
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007766 }
7767 else
7768 return true;
7769 }
7770 return false;
7771}
7772
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007773/// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
7774/// llvm::array_pod_sort.
7775static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
7776 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
7777 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007778}
7779
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007780/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007781/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
7782/// the given common base.
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007783/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
7784/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
7785static
7786void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007787 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007788 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
7789 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007790 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007791
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007792 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
7793 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
7794 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
7795 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007796
7797 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
7798 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
7799
7800 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7801 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
7802 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007803 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007804
7805 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
7806 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
7807
7808 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS.
7809 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
7810
7811 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
7812 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
7813 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007814 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007815
7816 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
7817 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
7818
7819 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
7820 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
7821 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
7822 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
7823 }
7824
7825 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
7826 // the protocols within the intersection.
7827 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
7828 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
7829
7830 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
7831 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
7832 IntersectionSet.erase(
7833 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
7834 IntersectionSet.end(),
7835 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
7836 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
7837 }),
7838 IntersectionSet.end());
7839 }
7840
7841 // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
7842 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
7843 compareObjCProtocolsByName);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007844}
7845
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007846/// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
7847static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
7848 QualType rhs) {
7849 // Common case: two object pointers.
7850 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7851 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7852 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
7853 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
7854
7855 // Two block pointers.
7856 const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7857 const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
7858 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
7859 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
7860
7861 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
7862 // acceptable.
7863 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
7864 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
7865 return true;
7866
7867 return false;
7868}
7869
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007870// Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007871static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
7872 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
7873 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007874 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
7875 bool stripKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007876 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
7877 return false;
7878
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007879 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007880 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007881 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7882 continue;
7883
7884 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
7885 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007886 if (!stripKindOf ||
7887 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
7888 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
7889 return false;
7890 }
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007891 break;
7892
7893 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
7894 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
7895 return false;
7896 break;
7897
7898 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
7899 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
7900 return false;
7901 break;
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007902 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007903 }
7904
7905 return true;
7906}
7907
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007908QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007909 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
7910 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007911 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
7912 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
7913 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
7914 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007915
7916 if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00007917 return QualType();
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007918
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007919 // When either LHS or RHS is a kindof type, we should return a kindof type.
7920 // For example, for common base of kindof(ASub1) and kindof(ASub2), we return
7921 // kindof(A).
7922 bool anyKindOf = LHS->isKindOfType() || RHS->isKindOfType();
7923
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007924 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
7925 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
7926 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
7927 LHSAncestors;
7928 while (true) {
7929 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
7930 // path from the LHS to the root.
7931 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007932
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007933 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
7934 // Get the type arguments.
7935 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7936 bool anyChanges = false;
7937 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7938 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007939 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7940 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007941 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007942 return QualType();
7943 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7944 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7945 // arguments.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00007946 LHSTypeArgs = {};
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007947 anyChanges = true;
7948 }
7949
7950 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007951 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007952 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7953 Protocols);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007954 if (!Protocols.empty())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007955 anyChanges = true;
7956
7957 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007958 // If we need to return a kindof type but LHS is not a kindof type, we
7959 // build a new result type.
7960 if (anyChanges || LHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007961 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007962 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00007963 anyKindOf || LHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007964 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7965 }
7966
7967 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00007968 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007969
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007970 // Find the superclass.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00007971 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
7972 if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
7973 break;
7974
7975 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7976 }
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007977
7978 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
7979 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
7980 while (true) {
7981 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
7982 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
7983 LHS = KnownLHS->second;
7984
7985 // Get the type arguments.
7986 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7987 bool anyChanges = false;
7988 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7989 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00007990 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7991 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00007992 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007993 return QualType();
7994 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7995 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7996 // arguments.
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00007997 RHSTypeArgs = {};
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00007998 anyChanges = true;
7999 }
8000
8001 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
8002 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
8003 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
8004 Protocols);
8005 if (!Protocols.empty())
8006 anyChanges = true;
8007
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00008008 // If we need to return a kindof type but RHS is not a kindof type, we
8009 // build a new result type.
8010 if (anyChanges || RHS->isKindOfType() != anyKindOf) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008011 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00008012 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
Manman Renc46f7d12016-05-06 19:35:02 +00008013 anyKindOf || RHS->isKindOfType());
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008014 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
8015 }
8016
8017 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
8018 }
8019
8020 // Find the superclass of the RHS.
8021 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
8022 if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
8023 break;
8024
8025 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8026 }
8027
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00008028 return QualType();
8029}
8030
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008031bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
8032 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
8033 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
8034 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
8035
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008036 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
8037 // the LHS.
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008038 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
8039 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
8040 if (!IsSuperClass)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008041 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008042
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008043 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
8044 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
8045 // LHS).
8046 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00008047 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
8048 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
8049 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
8050 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
8051 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
8052 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
8053 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
8054 // qualifiers.
8055 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008056 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00008057 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
8058 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00008059 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian12f7ef32014-10-13 21:07:45 +00008060
8061 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
8062 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
8063 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
8064 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
8065 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
8066 break;
8067 }
8068 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
8069 return false;
8070 }
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008071 }
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008072
8073 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
8074 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
8075 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
8076 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
8077 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
8078 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
8079 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8080
8081 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008082 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
Douglas Gregor1ac1b632015-07-07 03:58:54 +00008083 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
8084 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
Douglas Gregorab209d82015-07-07 03:58:42 +00008085 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregorc5e07f52015-07-07 03:58:01 +00008086 return false;
Douglas Gregore83b9562015-07-07 03:57:53 +00008087 }
8088 }
8089
8090 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00008091}
8092
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00008093bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8094 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008095 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8096 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008097
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008098 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00008099 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008100
8101 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
8102 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00008103}
8104
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00008105bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
8106 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
8107 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8108 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
8109}
8110
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008111/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008112/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008113/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008114/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008115bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
8116 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008117 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008118 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
Joey Gouly5788b782016-11-18 14:10:54 +00008119
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008120 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008121}
8122
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00008123bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00008124 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00008125}
8126
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008127bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8128 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
8129}
8130
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00008131/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
8132/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
8133/// QualType()
8134QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
8135 bool OfBlockPointer,
8136 bool Unqualified) {
8137 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
8138 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
8139 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
Aaron Ballmane8a8bae2014-03-08 20:12:42 +00008140 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
8141 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00008142 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
8143 if (!MT.isNull())
8144 return MT;
8145 }
8146 }
8147 }
8148
8149 return QualType();
8150}
8151
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008152/// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
8153/// parameter types
8154QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
8155 bool OfBlockPointer,
8156 bool Unqualified) {
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00008157 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
8158 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
8159 // type is compatible with a union member
8160 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
8161 Unqualified);
8162 if (!lmerge.isNull())
8163 return lmerge;
8164
8165 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
8166 Unqualified);
8167 if (!rmerge.isNull())
8168 return rmerge;
8169
8170 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
8171}
8172
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008173QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008174 bool OfBlockPointer,
8175 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008176 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
8177 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008178 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
8179 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008180 bool allLTypes = true;
8181 bool allRTypes = true;
8182
8183 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008184 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00008185 if (OfBlockPointer) {
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008186 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
8187 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00008188 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
8189 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
8190 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008191 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00008192 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008193 else
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008194 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008195 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008196 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008197
8198 if (Unqualified)
8199 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
8200
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008201 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
8202 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008203 if (Unqualified) {
8204 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
8205 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
8206 }
8207
8208 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008209 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008210 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008211 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008212
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00008213 // FIXME: double check this
8214 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
8215 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
8216 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00008217 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
8218 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008219
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00008220 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00008221 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00008222 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008223
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008224 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00008225 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
8226 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008227 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
8228 return QualType();
8229
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008230 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
8231 return QualType();
Oren Ben Simhon318a6ea2017-04-27 12:01:00 +00008232 if (lbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() != rbaseInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs())
8233 return QualType();
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008234
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008235 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
8236 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008237
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00008238 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
8239 allLTypes = false;
8240 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
8241 allRTypes = false;
8242
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008243 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008244
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008245 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00008246 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
8247 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008248 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
8249 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008250 return QualType();
8251
8252 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
8253 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
8254 return QualType();
8255
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00008256 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
8257 return QualType();
8258
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008259 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> newParamInfos;
8260 bool canUseLeft, canUseRight;
8261 if (!mergeExtParameterInfo(lproto, rproto, canUseLeft, canUseRight,
8262 newParamInfos))
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008263 return QualType();
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008264
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008265 if (!canUseLeft)
8266 allLTypes = false;
8267 if (!canUseRight)
8268 allRTypes = false;
8269
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008270 // Check parameter type compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008271 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008272 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
8273 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
8274 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
8275 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
8276 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
8277 if (paramType.isNull())
8278 return QualType();
8279
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008280 if (Unqualified)
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008281 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
8282
8283 types.push_back(paramType);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008284 if (Unqualified) {
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008285 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
8286 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008287 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008288
8289 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008290 allLTypes = false;
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008291 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008292 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008293 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008294
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008295 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8296 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008297
8298 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
8299 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008300 EPI.ExtParameterInfos =
8301 newParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : newParamInfos.data();
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00008302 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008303 }
8304
8305 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
8306 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
8307
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008308 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008309 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00008310 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008311 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
8312 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
8313 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
8314 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
8315 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
8316 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008317 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
8318 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008319
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00008320 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00008321 // to pass enum values.
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008322 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
8323 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
8324 if (paramTy.isNull())
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00008325 return QualType();
8326 }
Alp Toker601b22c2014-01-21 23:35:24 +00008327
8328 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
8329 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008330 return QualType();
8331 }
8332
8333 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8334 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008335
8336 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
8337 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008338 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008339 }
8340
8341 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
8342 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00008343 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008344}
8345
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008346/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
8347static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
8348 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
8349 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
8350 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
8351 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
8352 // type.
8353 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
8354 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
8355 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
8356 return other;
8357
8358 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
8359 // integral type of the same size.
8360 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
8361 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
8362 return other;
8363
8364 return QualType();
8365}
8366
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008367QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008368 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008369 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00008370 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
8371 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
8372 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00008373 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
8374 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008375 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
8376 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008377
8378 if (Unqualified) {
8379 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
8380 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
8381 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00008382
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008383 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
8384 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
8385
8386 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
8387 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
8388 return LHS;
8389
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008390 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00008391 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8392 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008393 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
8394 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
8395 // mismatch.
8396 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008397 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
Roger Ferrer Ibanezd93add32017-02-24 08:41:09 +00008398 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime() ||
8399 LQuals.hasUnaligned() != RQuals.hasUnaligned())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008400 return QualType();
8401
8402 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
8403 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
8404 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
8405 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
8406 // qualified __strong.
8407 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8408 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8409 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
8410
8411 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8412 return QualType();
8413
8414 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8415 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
8416 }
8417 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8418 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
8419 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008420 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00008421 }
8422
8423 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008424
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00008425 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
8426 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008427
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008428 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
8429 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
8430 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
8431 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00008432
8433 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00008434 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
8435 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
8436 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
8437 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008438
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008439 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
8440 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
8441 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
8442
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00008443 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
8444 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
8445 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008446
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00008447 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008448 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008449 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
8450 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008451 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008452 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00008453 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008454 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00008455 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00008456 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00008457 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00008458 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
8459 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
8460 return LHS;
8461 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
8462 return RHS;
8463 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00008464
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008465 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008466 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008467
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00008468 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008469 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008470#define TYPE(Class, Base)
8471#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00008472#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008473#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
8474#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
8475#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008476 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008477
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00008478 case Type::Auto:
Richard Smith600b5262017-01-26 20:40:47 +00008479 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00008480 case Type::LValueReference:
8481 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008482 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008483 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008484
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008485 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008486 case Type::IncompleteArray:
8487 case Type::VariableArray:
8488 case Type::FunctionProto:
8489 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008490 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008491
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008492 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008493 {
8494 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008495 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8496 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008497 if (Unqualified) {
8498 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8499 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8500 }
8501 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
8502 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008503 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00008504 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008505 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00008506 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008507 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008508 return getPointerType(ResultType);
8509 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00008510 case Type::BlockPointer:
8511 {
8512 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008513 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8514 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008515 if (Unqualified) {
8516 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8517 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
8518 }
Anastasia Stulova81a25e352017-03-10 15:23:07 +00008519 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
8520 Qualifiers LHSPteeQual = LHSPointee.getQualifiers();
8521 Qualifiers RHSPteeQual = RHSPointee.getQualifiers();
8522 // Blocks can't be an expression in a ternary operator (OpenCL v2.0
8523 // 6.12.5) thus the following check is asymmetric.
8524 if (!LHSPteeQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(RHSPteeQual))
8525 return QualType();
8526 LHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace();
8527 RHSPteeQual.removeAddressSpace();
8528 LHSPointee =
8529 QualType(LHSPointee.getTypePtr(), LHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue());
8530 RHSPointee =
8531 QualType(RHSPointee.getTypePtr(), RHSPteeQual.getAsOpaqueValue());
8532 }
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008533 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
8534 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00008535 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8536 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8537 return LHS;
8538 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8539 return RHS;
8540 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
8541 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00008542 case Type::Atomic:
8543 {
8544 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
8545 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
8546 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
8547 if (Unqualified) {
8548 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8549 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
8550 }
8551 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
8552 Unqualified);
8553 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
8554 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8555 return LHS;
8556 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8557 return RHS;
8558 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
8559 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008560 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008561 {
8562 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
8563 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
8564 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
8565 return QualType();
8566
8567 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
8568 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008569 if (Unqualified) {
8570 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
8571 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
8572 }
8573
8574 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008575 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008576 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8577 return LHS;
8578 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8579 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00008580 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
8581 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
8582 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
8583 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008584 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
8585 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008586 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8587 return LHS;
8588 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
8589 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008590 if (LVAT) {
8591 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
8592 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
8593 // has to be different.
8594 return LHS;
8595 }
8596 if (RVAT) {
8597 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
8598 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
8599 // has to be different.
8600 return RHS;
8601 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00008602 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
8603 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00008604 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
8605 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008606 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008607 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00008608 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008609 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008610 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008611 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00008612 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00008613 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008614 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00008615 case Type::Complex:
8616 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
8617 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00008618 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00008619 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00008620 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
8621 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008622 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00008623 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008624 case Type::ObjCObject: {
8625 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00008626 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
8627 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00008628 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8629 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
8630 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00008631 return LHS;
8632
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00008633 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00008634 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00008635 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008636 if (OfBlockPointer) {
8637 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
8638 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00008639 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8640 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008641 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00008642 return QualType();
8643 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00008644 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
8645 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00008646 return LHS;
8647
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00008648 return QualType();
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00008649 case Type::Pipe:
Joey Goulye3c85de2016-12-01 11:30:49 +00008650 assert(LHS != RHS &&
8651 "Equivalent pipe types should have already been handled!");
8652 return QualType();
Xiuli Pan9c14e282016-01-09 12:53:17 +00008653 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00008654
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00008655 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00008656}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00008657
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008658bool ASTContext::mergeExtParameterInfo(
8659 const FunctionProtoType *FirstFnType, const FunctionProtoType *SecondFnType,
8660 bool &CanUseFirst, bool &CanUseSecond,
8661 SmallVectorImpl<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo> &NewParamInfos) {
8662 assert(NewParamInfos.empty() && "param info list not empty");
8663 CanUseFirst = CanUseSecond = true;
8664 bool FirstHasInfo = FirstFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
8665 bool SecondHasInfo = SecondFnType->hasExtParameterInfos();
8666
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008667 // Fast path: if the first type doesn't have ext parameter infos,
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008668 // we match if and only if the second type also doesn't have them.
8669 if (!FirstHasInfo && !SecondHasInfo)
8670 return true;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008671
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008672 bool NeedParamInfo = false;
8673 size_t E = FirstHasInfo ? FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size()
8674 : SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfos().size();
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008675
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008676 for (size_t I = 0; I < E; ++I) {
8677 FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo FirstParam, SecondParam;
8678 if (FirstHasInfo)
8679 FirstParam = FirstFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I);
8680 if (SecondHasInfo)
8681 SecondParam = SecondFnType->getExtParameterInfo(I);
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008682
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008683 // Cannot merge unless everything except the noescape flag matches.
8684 if (FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(false) != SecondParam.withIsNoEscape(false))
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008685 return false;
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008686
8687 bool FirstNoEscape = FirstParam.isNoEscape();
8688 bool SecondNoEscape = SecondParam.isNoEscape();
8689 bool IsNoEscape = FirstNoEscape && SecondNoEscape;
8690 NewParamInfos.push_back(FirstParam.withIsNoEscape(IsNoEscape));
8691 if (NewParamInfos.back().getOpaqueValue())
8692 NeedParamInfo = true;
8693 if (FirstNoEscape != IsNoEscape)
8694 CanUseFirst = false;
8695 if (SecondNoEscape != IsNoEscape)
8696 CanUseSecond = false;
John McCall18afab72016-03-01 00:49:02 +00008697 }
Akira Hatanaka98a49332017-09-22 00:41:05 +00008698
8699 if (!NeedParamInfo)
8700 NewParamInfos.clear();
8701
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00008702 return true;
8703}
8704
Chandler Carruth21c90602015-12-30 03:24:14 +00008705void ASTContext::ResetObjCLayout(const ObjCContainerDecl *CD) {
8706 ObjCLayouts[CD] = nullptr;
8707}
8708
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008709/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
8710/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
8711/// return types.
8712QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
8713 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
8714 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
8715 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
8716 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
8717 return LHS;
8718 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
8719 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
8720 return QualType();
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008721 QualType OldReturnType =
8722 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008723 QualType NewReturnType =
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00008724 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008725 QualType ResReturnType =
8726 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
8727 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
8728 return QualType();
8729 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
8730 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
8731 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
8732 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
8733 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00008734 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
8735 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Reid Kleckner896b32f2013-06-10 20:51:09 +00008736 QualType ResultType =
Alp Toker9cacbab2014-01-20 20:26:09 +00008737 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00008738 return ResultType;
8739 }
8740 }
8741 return QualType();
8742 }
8743
8744 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
8745 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8746 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
8747 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
8748 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
8749 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
8750 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
8751 return QualType();
8752
8753 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
8754 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
8755 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
8756 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
8757 // qualified __strong.
8758 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8759 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
8760 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
8761
8762 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
8763 return QualType();
8764
8765 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
8766 return LHS;
8767 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
8768 return RHS;
8769 return QualType();
8770 }
8771
8772 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8773 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8774 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8775 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
8776 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
8777 return LHS;
8778 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
8779 return RHS;
8780 }
8781 return QualType();
8782}
8783
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00008784//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008785// Integer Predicates
8786//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00008787
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008788unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
Richard Smithe9521062013-10-15 04:56:17 +00008789 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00008790 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00008791 if (T->isBooleanType())
8792 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00008793 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008794 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
8795}
8796
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00008797QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00008798 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008799
8800 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
8801 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
8802 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00008803 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008804
8805 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
8806 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008807 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00008808
8809 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8810 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008811 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
8812 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
8813 case BuiltinType::SChar:
8814 return UnsignedCharTy;
8815 case BuiltinType::Short:
8816 return UnsignedShortTy;
8817 case BuiltinType::Int:
8818 return UnsignedIntTy;
8819 case BuiltinType::Long:
8820 return UnsignedLongTy;
8821 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
8822 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00008823 case BuiltinType::Int128:
8824 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008825 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008826 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00008827 }
8828}
8829
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00008830ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() = default;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00008831
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00008832void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
8833 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008834
8835//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8836// Builtin Type Computation
8837//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8838
8839/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008840/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
8841/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
8842/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
8843/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008844///
8845/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
8846/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00008847static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008848 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00008849 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008850 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008851 // Modifiers.
8852 int HowLong = 0;
8853 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008854 RequiresICE = false;
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00008855
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00008856 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008857 bool Done = false;
8858 #ifndef NDEBUG
8859 bool IsSpecialLong = false;
8860 #endif
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008861 while (!Done) {
8862 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008863 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008864 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00008865 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00008866 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008867 case 'S':
8868 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
8869 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
8870 Signed = true;
8871 break;
8872 case 'U':
8873 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008874 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008875 Unsigned = true;
8876 break;
8877 case 'L':
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008878 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use 'L' with 'W' or 'N' modifiers");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008879 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
8880 ++HowLong;
8881 break;
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00008882 case 'N':
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008883 // 'N' behaves like 'L' for all non LP64 targets and 'int' otherwise.
8884 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use two 'N' or 'W' modifiers!");
8885 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'N' modifiers!");
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008886 #ifndef NDEBUG
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008887 IsSpecialLong = true;
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008888 #endif
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008889 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32)
8890 ++HowLong;
8891 break;
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008892 case 'W':
8893 // This modifier represents int64 type.
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008894 assert(!IsSpecialLong && "Can't use two 'N' or 'W' modifiers!");
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008895 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008896 #ifndef NDEBUG
Bruno Cardoso Lopesafa47c92017-06-21 02:20:46 +00008897 IsSpecialLong = true;
Eric Christopher50daf5f2017-07-10 21:28:54 +00008898 #endif
Kevin Qinad64f6d2014-02-24 02:45:03 +00008899 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
8900 default:
8901 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
8902 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
8903 HowLong = 1;
8904 break;
8905 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
8906 HowLong = 2;
8907 break;
8908 }
Duncan P. N. Exon Smitheae8caa2017-06-14 21:26:31 +00008909 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008910 }
8911 }
8912
8913 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008914
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008915 // Read the base type.
8916 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008917 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008918 case 'v':
8919 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8920 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
8921 Type = Context.VoidTy;
8922 break;
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008923 case 'h':
8924 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
Sean Silva2a995142015-01-16 21:44:26 +00008925 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
Jack Carter24bef982013-08-15 15:16:57 +00008926 Type = Context.HalfTy;
8927 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008928 case 'f':
8929 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8930 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
8931 Type = Context.FloatTy;
8932 break;
8933 case 'd':
8934 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
8935 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
8936 if (HowLong)
8937 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
8938 else
8939 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
8940 break;
8941 case 's':
8942 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
8943 if (Unsigned)
8944 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
8945 else
8946 Type = Context.ShortTy;
8947 break;
8948 case 'i':
8949 if (HowLong == 3)
8950 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
8951 else if (HowLong == 2)
8952 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
8953 else if (HowLong == 1)
8954 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
8955 else
8956 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
8957 break;
8958 case 'c':
8959 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
8960 if (Signed)
8961 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
8962 else if (Unsigned)
8963 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
8964 else
8965 Type = Context.CharTy;
8966 break;
8967 case 'b': // boolean
8968 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
8969 Type = Context.BoolTy;
8970 break;
8971 case 'z': // size_t.
8972 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
8973 Type = Context.getSizeType();
8974 break;
Richard Smith8110c9d2016-11-29 19:45:17 +00008975 case 'w': // wchar_t.
8976 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'w'!");
8977 Type = Context.getWideCharType();
8978 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008979 case 'F':
8980 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
8981 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00008982 case 'G':
8983 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
8984 break;
8985 case 'H':
8986 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
8987 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00008988 case 'M':
8989 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
8990 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00008991 case 'a':
8992 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8993 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
8994 break;
8995 case 'A':
8996 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
8997 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
8998 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
8999 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
9000 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
9001 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
9002 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
9003 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
9004 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
9005 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009006 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009007 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009008 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009009 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009010 break;
9011 case 'V': {
9012 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009013 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
9014 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009015 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009016
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009017 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
9018 RequiresICE, false);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009019 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009020
9021 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00009022 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00009023 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009024 break;
9025 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00009026 case 'E': {
9027 char *End;
9028
9029 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
9030 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
9031
9032 Str = End;
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009033
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00009034 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009035 false);
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00009036 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
9037 break;
9038 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00009039 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009040 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009041 false);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009042 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00009043 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
9044 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00009045 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009046 case 'Y':
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00009047 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
9048 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00009049 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00009050 Type = Context.getFILEType();
9051 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009052 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009053 return QualType();
9054 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00009055 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00009056 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009057 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00009058 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009059 else
9060 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
9061
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00009062 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00009063 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00009064 return QualType();
9065 }
9066 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00009067 case 'K':
9068 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
9069 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
9070
9071 if (Type.isNull()) {
9072 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
9073 return QualType();
9074 }
9075 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00009076 case 'p':
9077 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
9078 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00009079 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009080
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009081 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
9082 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009083 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00009084 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009085 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
9086 case '*':
9087 case '&': {
9088 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
9089 // qualified with an address space.
9090 char *End;
9091 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
9092 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009093 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type,
9094 getLangASFromTargetAS(AddrSpace));
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00009095 Str = End;
9096 }
9097 if (c == '*')
9098 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
9099 else
9100 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
9101 break;
9102 }
9103 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
9104 case 'C':
9105 Type = Type.withConst();
9106 break;
9107 case 'D':
9108 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
9109 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00009110 case 'R':
9111 Type = Type.withRestrict();
9112 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009113 }
9114 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00009115
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009116 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00009117 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009118
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009119 return Type;
9120}
9121
9122/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009123QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
9124 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
9125 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Eric Christopher02d5d862015-08-06 01:01:12 +00009126 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.getTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009127
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009128 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009129
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009130 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009131 Error = GE_None;
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009132 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
9133 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009134 if (Error != GE_None)
9135 return QualType();
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009136
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009137 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009138
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009139 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chandler Carruth45bbe012017-03-24 09:11:57 +00009140 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009141 if (Error != GE_None)
9142 return QualType();
9143
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00009144 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
9145 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
9146 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
9147 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
9148
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009149 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
9150 if (Ty->isArrayType())
9151 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009152
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009153 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
9154 }
9155
David Majnemerba3e5ec2015-03-13 18:26:17 +00009156 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
9157 return QualType();
9158
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009159 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
9160 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
9161
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009162 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00009163 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
9164
9165 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
9166
Richard Smith836de6b2016-12-19 23:59:34 +00009167 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here.
9168 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00009169 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00009170
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00009171 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00009172 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
9173 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
Richard Smith391fb862016-10-18 07:13:55 +00009174 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(Id))
9175 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type =
9176 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? EST_BasicNoexcept : EST_DynamicNone;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00009177
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00009178 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00009179}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00009180
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009181static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
9182 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009183 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009184 return GVA_Internal;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009185
Richard Smithe2467b72017-11-16 23:54:56 +00009186 // Non-user-provided functions get emitted as weak definitions with every
9187 // use, no matter whether they've been explicitly instantiated etc.
9188 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
9189 if (!MD->isUserProvided())
9190 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
9191
Yaron Keren4cd211b2017-02-22 14:32:39 +00009192 GVALinkage External;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009193 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
9194 case TSK_Undeclared:
9195 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
9196 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
9197 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009198
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009199 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009200 return GVA_StrongODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009201
David Majnemerc3d07332014-05-15 06:25:57 +00009202 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
9203 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
9204 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
9205 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
9206 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
9207 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009208 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009209 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
9210
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009211 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009212 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009213 break;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009214 }
9215
9216 if (!FD->isInlined())
9217 return External;
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00009218
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00009219 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
9220 !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009221 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
David Majnemer62f0ffd2013-08-01 17:26:42 +00009222 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009223 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
9224
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009225 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
9226 // externally visible.
9227 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
9228 return External;
9229
9230 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009231 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009232 }
9233
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009234 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
9235 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
9236 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
David Majnemer73768702015-03-20 00:02:27 +00009237 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009238 return GVA_StrongODR;
9239
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009240 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009241}
9242
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00009243static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(const ASTContext &Context,
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009244 const Decl *D, GVALinkage L) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009245 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
9246 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
9247 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
9248 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
9249 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00009250 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009251 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
9252 return GVA_StrongODR;
Artem Belevichca2b9512016-05-02 20:30:03 +00009253 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice &&
9254 D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) {
9255 // Device-side functions with __global__ attribute must always be
9256 // visible externally so they can be launched from host.
9257 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_Internal)
9258 return GVA_StrongODR;
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009259 }
9260 return L;
9261}
9262
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009263/// Adjust the GVALinkage for a declaration based on what an external AST source
9264/// knows about whether there can be other definitions of this declaration.
9265static GVALinkage
9266adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(const ASTContext &Ctx, const Decl *D,
9267 GVALinkage L) {
9268 ExternalASTSource *Source = Ctx.getExternalSource();
9269 if (!Source)
9270 return L;
9271
9272 switch (Source->hasExternalDefinitions(D)) {
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009273 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Never:
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009274 // Other translation units rely on us to provide the definition.
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009275 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
9276 return GVA_StrongODR;
9277 break;
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009278
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009279 case ExternalASTSource::EK_Always:
9280 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009281
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009282 case ExternalASTSource::EK_ReplyHazy:
9283 break;
9284 }
9285 return L;
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009286}
9287
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009288GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
9289 return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, FD,
9290 adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, FD,
9291 basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD)));
9292}
9293
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009294static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
9295 const VarDecl *VD) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009296 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
9297 return GVA_Internal;
9298
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009299 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009300 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
9301 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
9302 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
9303
David Blaikieeb210012017-01-27 23:11:10 +00009304 // ObjC Blocks can create local variables that don't have a FunctionDecl
9305 // LexicalContext.
9306 if (!LexicalContext)
9307 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009308
David Blaikieeb210012017-01-27 23:11:10 +00009309 // Otherwise, let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the
9310 // nearest enclosing function.
9311 auto StaticLocalLinkage =
9312 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
9313
9314 // Itanium ABI 5.2.2: "Each COMDAT group [for a static local variable] must
9315 // be emitted in any object with references to the symbol for the object it
9316 // contains, whether inline or out-of-line."
9317 // Similar behavior is observed with MSVC. An alternative ABI could use
9318 // StrongODR/AvailableExternally to match the function, but none are
9319 // known/supported currently.
9320 if (StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ||
9321 StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
9322 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
9323 return StaticLocalLinkage;
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009324 }
9325
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00009326 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
9327 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
9328 // cause link errors.
9329 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
9330 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
9331
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00009332 // Most non-template variables have strong linkage; inline variables are
9333 // linkonce_odr or (occasionally, for compatibility) weak_odr.
9334 GVALinkage StrongLinkage;
9335 switch (Context.getInlineVariableDefinitionKind(VD)) {
9336 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::None:
9337 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongExternal;
9338 break;
9339 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Weak:
9340 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::WeakUnknown:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009341 StrongLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
Richard Smithd9b90092016-07-02 01:32:16 +00009342 break;
9343 case ASTContext::InlineVariableDefinitionKind::Strong:
9344 StrongLinkage = GVA_StrongODR;
9345 break;
9346 }
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009347
Richard Smith8809a0c2013-09-27 20:14:12 +00009348 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009349 case TSK_Undeclared:
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009350 return StrongLinkage;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009351
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00009352 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
David Majnemer3f021502015-10-08 04:53:31 +00009353 return Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
9354 VD->isStaticDataMember()
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00009355 ? GVA_StrongODR
Richard Smith62f19e72016-06-25 00:15:56 +00009356 : StrongLinkage;
David Majnemer6d1780c2015-07-17 23:36:49 +00009357
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009358 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
David Majnemer54e3ba52014-04-02 23:17:29 +00009359 return GVA_StrongODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009360
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009361 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
9362 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
9363
Rafael Espindola3ae00052013-05-13 00:12:11 +00009364 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
David Majnemer27d69db2014-04-28 22:17:59 +00009365 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009366 }
Rafael Espindola27699c82013-05-13 14:05:53 +00009367
9368 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009369}
9370
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009371GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009372 return adjustGVALinkageForExternalDefinitionKind(*this, VD,
9373 adjustGVALinkageForAttributes(*this, VD,
9374 basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD)));
Hans Wennborgb0f2f142014-05-15 22:07:49 +00009375}
9376
David Blaikiee6b7c282017-04-11 20:46:34 +00009377bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009378 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
9379 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
9380 return false;
Renato Golin9258aa52014-05-21 10:40:27 +00009381 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
9382 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
9383 return false;
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00009384 if (VD->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
9385 isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
9386 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00009387 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
9388 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
9389 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
9390 return false;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00009391 } else if (isa<PragmaCommentDecl>(D))
9392 return true;
Dmitry Polukhin0b0da292016-04-06 11:38:59 +00009393 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D) ||
9394 D->hasAttr<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr>())
9395 return true;
Nico Webercbbaeb12016-03-02 19:28:54 +00009396 else if (isa<PragmaDetectMismatchDecl>(D))
9397 return true;
Nico Weber66220292016-03-02 17:28:48 +00009398 else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
Alexey Bataevc5b1d322016-03-04 09:22:22 +00009399 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
9400 else if (isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(D))
9401 return !D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext();
Richard Smithdc1f0422016-07-20 19:10:16 +00009402 else if (isa<ImportDecl>(D))
9403 return true;
Alexey Bataev97720002014-11-11 04:05:39 +00009404 else
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00009405 return false;
9406
9407 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
9408 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009409 return false;
9410
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00009411 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
9412 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
9413 return false;
9414
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009415 // Aliases and used decls are required.
9416 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
9417 return true;
9418
9419 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
9420 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00009421 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00009422 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009423
9424 // Constructors and destructors are required.
9425 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
9426 return true;
9427
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00009428 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
9429 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
9430 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
9431 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
9432 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
9433 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
9434 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
9435 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
9436 return true;
9437 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009438 }
9439 }
9440
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009441 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
9442
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009443 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
9444 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
9445 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
David Blaikie9ffe5a32017-01-30 05:00:26 +00009446 return !isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009447 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00009448
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009449 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
9450 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
9451
Hans Wennborg56fc62b2014-07-17 20:25:23 +00009452 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
9453 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00009454 return false;
9455
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009456 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009457 auto Linkage = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
9458 if (!isDiscardableGVALinkage(Linkage))
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009459 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009460
Richard Smitha4653622017-09-06 20:01:14 +00009461 // We never need to emit a variable that is available in another TU.
9462 if (Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally)
9463 return false;
9464
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009465 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
9466 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
9467 return true;
9468
9469 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
Richard Smith7747ce22015-08-19 20:49:38 +00009470 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this) &&
Richard Smith187ffb42017-01-20 01:19:46 +00009471 // We can get a value-dependent initializer during error recovery.
9472 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue()))
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009473 return true;
9474
Richard Smithda383632016-08-15 01:33:41 +00009475 // Likewise, variables with tuple-like bindings are required if their
9476 // bindings have side-effects.
9477 if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(VD))
9478 for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
9479 if (auto *BindingVD = BD->getHoldingVar())
9480 if (DeclMustBeEmitted(BindingVD))
9481 return true;
9482
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00009483 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00009484}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00009485
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009486CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
9487 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00009488 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Reid Kleckner78af0702013-08-27 23:08:25 +00009489 if (IsCXXMethod)
9490 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00009491
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00009492 switch (LangOpts.getDefaultCallingConv()) {
9493 case LangOptions::DCC_None:
9494 break;
9495 case LangOptions::DCC_CDecl:
9496 return CC_C;
9497 case LangOptions::DCC_FastCall:
Erich Keane5759fa72017-10-24 23:12:01 +00009498 if (getTargetInfo().hasFeature("sse2") && !IsVariadic)
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00009499 return CC_X86FastCall;
9500 break;
9501 case LangOptions::DCC_StdCall:
9502 if (!IsVariadic)
9503 return CC_X86StdCall;
9504 break;
9505 case LangOptions::DCC_VectorCall:
9506 // __vectorcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
9507 if (!IsVariadic)
9508 return CC_X86VectorCall;
9509 break;
Erich Keanea957ffb2017-11-02 21:08:00 +00009510 case LangOptions::DCC_RegCall:
9511 // __regcall cannot be applied to variadic functions.
9512 if (!IsVariadic)
9513 return CC_X86RegCall;
9514 break;
Alexey Bataeva7547182016-05-18 09:06:38 +00009515 }
Alexander Kornienko21de0ae2015-01-20 11:20:41 +00009516 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00009517}
9518
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00009519bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00009520 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
9521 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
9522}
9523
Reid Kleckner96f8f932014-02-05 17:27:08 +00009524VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
9525 if (!VTContext.get()) {
9526 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9527 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
9528 else
9529 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
9530 }
9531 return VTContext.get();
9532}
9533
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009534MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009535 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00009536 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009537 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
9538 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
Zoran Jovanovic26a12162015-02-18 15:21:35 +00009539 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009540 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Tim Northovera2ee4332014-03-29 15:09:45 +00009541 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
Dan Gohmanc2853072015-09-03 22:51:53 +00009542 case TargetCXXABI::WebAssembly:
Tim Northover756447a2015-10-30 16:30:36 +00009543 case TargetCXXABI::WatchOS:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00009544 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00009545 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Timur Iskhodzhanov67455222013-10-03 06:26:13 +00009546 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009547 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009548 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00009549}
9550
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009551CXXABI::~CXXABI() = default;
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00009552
9553size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Larisse Voufo39a1e502013-08-06 01:03:05 +00009554 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
9555 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
9556 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
9557 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
9558 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
9559 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
9560 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
9561 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
9562 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
9563 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
9564 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
9565 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
9566 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
9567 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00009568}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00009569
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00009570/// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
9571/// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
9572/// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
9573/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
9574QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
9575 unsigned Signed) const {
9576 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
9577 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
9578 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
9579 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
9580 return QualTy;
9581}
9582
9583/// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
9584/// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
9585/// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
9586QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
9587 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
9588 switch (Ty) {
9589 case TargetInfo::Float:
9590 return FloatTy;
9591 case TargetInfo::Double:
9592 return DoubleTy;
9593 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
9594 return LongDoubleTy;
Nemanja Ivanovicbb1ea2d2016-05-09 08:52:33 +00009595 case TargetInfo::Float128:
9596 return Float128Ty;
Stepan Dyatkovskiy5a637922013-09-05 11:23:21 +00009597 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
9598 return QualType();
9599 }
9600
9601 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
9602}
9603
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009604void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
9605 if (Number > 1)
9606 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00009607}
9608
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009609unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00009610 auto I = MangleNumbers.find(ND);
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009611 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00009612}
9613
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00009614void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
9615 if (Number > 1)
9616 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
9617}
9618
9619unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
Richard Smithe9b02d62016-03-21 22:33:02 +00009620 auto I = StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
David Majnemer2206bf52014-03-05 08:57:59 +00009621 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
9622}
9623
Eli Friedman3b7d46c2013-07-10 00:30:46 +00009624MangleNumberingContext &
9625ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009626 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
Justin Lebar20ebffc2016-10-10 16:26:19 +00009627 std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext> &MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009628 if (!MCtx)
9629 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
9630 return *MCtx;
9631}
9632
Justin Lebar20ebffc2016-10-10 16:26:19 +00009633std::unique_ptr<MangleNumberingContext>
9634ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
Reid Klecknerd8110b62013-09-10 20:14:30 +00009635 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00009636}
9637
David Majnemere7a818f2015-03-06 18:53:55 +00009638const CXXConstructorDecl *
9639ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
9640 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
9641 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
9642}
9643
9644void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
9645 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
9646 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
9647 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
9648 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
9649}
9650
David Majnemer00350522015-08-31 18:48:39 +00009651void ASTContext::addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
9652 TypedefNameDecl *DD) {
9653 return ABI->addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
9654}
9655
9656TypedefNameDecl *
9657ASTContext::getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
9658 return ABI->getTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
9659}
9660
9661void ASTContext::addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TagDecl *TD,
9662 DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
9663 return ABI->addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD, DD);
9664}
9665
9666DeclaratorDecl *ASTContext::getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(const TagDecl *TD) {
9667 return ABI->getDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(TD);
9668}
9669
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00009670void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
9671 ParamIndices[D] = index;
9672}
9673
9674unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
9675 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
9676 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
9677 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
9678 return I->second;
9679}
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009680
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009681APValue *
9682ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
9683 bool MayCreate) {
9684 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
9685 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00009686 if (MayCreate) {
9687 APValue *&MTVI = MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
9688 if (!MTVI)
9689 MTVI = new (*this) APValue;
9690 return MTVI;
9691 }
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009692
David Majnemer2dcef9e2015-08-13 23:50:15 +00009693 return MaterializedTemporaryValues.lookup(E);
Richard Smithe6c01442013-06-05 00:46:14 +00009694}
9695
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009696bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
9697 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
9698 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
9699 return false;
9700
Bob Wilson2c82c3d2013-11-02 23:27:49 +00009701 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
9702 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
9703 return false;
9704
Fariborz Jahanian615de762013-05-28 17:37:39 +00009705 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
9706 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
9707 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
9708 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
9709 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
9710 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
9711 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
9712}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009713
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009714static ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009715 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers::mapped_type U) {
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009716 if (const auto *D = U.dyn_cast<const Decl *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009717 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*D);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009718 if (const auto *S = U.dyn_cast<const Stmt *>())
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009719 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*S);
Benjamin Kramerfbfa7a12015-10-22 11:26:35 +00009720 return *U.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009721}
9722
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009723namespace {
9724
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009725/// Template specializations to abstract away from pointers and TypeLocs.
9726/// @{
9727template <typename T>
9728ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const T &Node) {
9729 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node);
9730}
9731template <>
9732ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode createDynTypedNode(const TypeLoc &Node) {
9733 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
9734}
9735template <>
9736ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode
9737createDynTypedNode(const NestedNameSpecifierLoc &Node) {
9738 return ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(Node);
9739}
9740/// @}
9741
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009742 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
9743 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
9744 ///
9745 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
9746 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
9747 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
9748 ///
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00009749 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009750 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009751 public:
9752 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
9753 ///
9754 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009755 static std::pair<ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *,
9756 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *>
9757 buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
9758 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMapPointers,
9759 new ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009760 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009761 return std::make_pair(Visitor.Parents, Visitor.OtherParents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009762 }
9763
9764 private:
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009765 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
9766
9767 using VisitorBase = RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009768
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009769 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents,
9770 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents)
9771 : Parents(Parents), OtherParents(OtherParents) {}
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009772
9773 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
9774 return true;
9775 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009776
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009777 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
9778 return true;
9779 }
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009780
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009781 template <typename T, typename MapNodeTy, typename BaseTraverseFn,
9782 typename MapTy>
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009783 bool TraverseNode(T Node, MapNodeTy MapNode,
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009784 BaseTraverseFn BaseTraverse, MapTy *Parents) {
Craig Topper36250ad2014-05-12 05:36:57 +00009785 if (!Node)
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009786 return true;
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009787 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
Benjamin Kramere8c51fd2015-10-21 10:07:26 +00009788 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
9789 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
9790 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
9791 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
9792 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
9793 // new matches.
9794 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
9795 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
9796 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
9797 // do not have pointer identity.
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009798 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[MapNode];
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009799 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009800 if (const auto *D = ParentStack.back().get<Decl>())
9801 NodeOrVector = D;
9802 else if (const auto *S = ParentStack.back().get<Stmt>())
9803 NodeOrVector = S;
9804 else
9805 NodeOrVector =
9806 new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009807 } else {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009808 if (!NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
9809 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(
9810 1, getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(NodeOrVector));
Gabor Horvath10a837a2017-04-19 15:11:10 +00009811 delete NodeOrVector
9812 .template dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
Benjamin Kramer422b3ff2015-10-23 13:24:18 +00009813 NodeOrVector = Vector;
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00009814 }
Samuel Benzaquen3ca0a7b2014-06-13 13:31:40 +00009815
9816 auto *Vector =
9817 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
9818 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
9819 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
9820 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
9821 // types.
9822 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
9823 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
9824 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
9825 if (!Found)
9826 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009827 }
9828 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009829 ParentStack.push_back(createDynTypedNode(Node));
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009830 bool Result = BaseTraverse();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009831 ParentStack.pop_back();
9832 return Result;
9833 }
9834
9835 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009836 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, DeclNode,
9837 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseDecl(DeclNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009838 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009839 }
9840
9841 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009842 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, StmtNode,
9843 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseStmt(StmtNode); },
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009844 Parents);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009845 }
9846
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009847 bool TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLoc TypeLocNode) {
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009848 return TraverseNode(
9849 TypeLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(TypeLocNode),
9850 [&] { return VisitorBase::TraverseTypeLoc(TypeLocNode); },
9851 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009852 }
9853
9854 bool TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLocNode) {
9855 return TraverseNode(
9856 NNSLocNode, ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(NNSLocNode),
Richard Smith85838722015-11-24 03:09:01 +00009857 [&] {
9858 return VisitorBase::TraverseNestedNameSpecifierLoc(NNSLocNode);
9859 },
9860 OtherParents);
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009861 }
9862
9863 ASTContext::ParentMapPointers *Parents;
9864 ASTContext::ParentMapOtherNodes *OtherParents;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009865 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009866 };
9867
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009868} // namespace
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009869
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009870template <typename NodeTy, typename MapTy>
9871static ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList getDynNodeFromMap(const NodeTy &Node,
9872 const MapTy &Map) {
9873 auto I = Map.find(Node);
9874 if (I == Map.end()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009875 return llvm::ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>();
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009876 }
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009877 if (auto *V = I->second.template dyn_cast<ASTContext::ParentVector *>()) {
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009878 return llvm::makeArrayRef(*V);
Manuel Klimek95403e62014-05-21 13:28:59 +00009879 }
Benjamin Kramer8e4a1762015-10-22 11:21:40 +00009880 return getSingleDynTypedNodeFromParentMap(I->second);
Reid Kleckner2ab0ac52013-06-17 12:56:08 +00009881}
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009882
Benjamin Kramer94355ae2015-10-23 09:04:55 +00009883ASTContext::DynTypedNodeList
9884ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
9885 if (!PointerParents) {
9886 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
9887 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
9888 auto Maps = ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl());
9889 PointerParents.reset(Maps.first);
9890 OtherParents.reset(Maps.second);
9891 }
9892 if (Node.getNodeKind().hasPointerIdentity())
9893 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node.getMemoizationData(), *PointerParents);
9894 return getDynNodeFromMap(Node, *OtherParents);
9895}
9896
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009897bool
9898ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
9899 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
9900 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
9901 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
9902 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
9903 return false;
9904 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
9905 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9906 return false;
Alp Toker314cc812014-01-25 16:55:45 +00009907 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009908 return false;
9909
9910 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
9911 return false;
9912
9913 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
9914 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
9915 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
9916 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
9917 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
9918 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
9919 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
9920 return false;
9921 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
9922 return false;
9923 }
Eugene Zelenko5e5e5642017-11-23 01:20:07 +00009924
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009925 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
Fariborz Jahaniand36150d2013-07-15 21:22:08 +00009926}
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009927
Yaxun Liu402804b2016-12-15 08:09:08 +00009928uint64_t ASTContext::getTargetNullPointerValue(QualType QT) const {
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009929 LangAS AS;
Yaxun Liu402804b2016-12-15 08:09:08 +00009930 if (QT->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType()->isNullPtrType())
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009931 AS = LangAS::Default;
Yaxun Liu402804b2016-12-15 08:09:08 +00009932 else
9933 AS = QT->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
9934
9935 return getTargetInfo().getNullPointerValue(AS);
9936}
9937
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009938unsigned ASTContext::getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS AS) const {
9939 if (isTargetAddressSpace(AS))
9940 return toTargetAddressSpace(AS);
Yaxun Liub34ec822017-04-11 17:24:23 +00009941 else
Alexander Richardson6d989432017-10-15 18:48:14 +00009942 return (*AddrSpaceMap)[(unsigned)AS];
Yaxun Liub34ec822017-04-11 17:24:23 +00009943}
9944
Richard Smith053f6c62014-05-16 23:01:30 +00009945// Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
9946// doesn't include ASTContext.h
9947template
9948clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9949 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
9950clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
9951 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
9952 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);